or1k: Support large plt_relocs when generating plt entries
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
250d07de 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
250d07de 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
250d07de 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
279d901e
L
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
5fa222e4
AM
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
cd6d6c15 1369@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1371
e6e2dfbd
AM
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1374
e6e2dfbd
AM
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1385
1386@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1388
1389@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1391
1392@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1394
6aa29e7b
JJ
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1405
e6e2dfbd
AM
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1410
cd6d6c15
NC
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1417
1418@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1420
6aa29e7b 1421@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1422@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1428
68b00778
L
1429@item report-relative-reloc
1430Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
47acac12
L
1433@item separate-code
1434@itemx noseparate-code
1435Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
496afd17
L
1440@item unique-symbol
1441@itemx nounique-symbol
1442Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
e6e2dfbd
AM
1446@item shstk
1447Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1450
04c3a755 1451@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1452Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1453Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
8ee10e86
AM
1456@item start-stop-gc
1457@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1458@cindex start-stop-gc
1459When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1460section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1461input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1462@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1463@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1464linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1465sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1466were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1467definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1468object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1469linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1470@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1471treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1472
cae64165
RM
1473@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1474@cindex visibility
1475@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1476Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1478Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1479@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1480start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1481compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1482recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1483programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1484between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1485
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486@item text
1487@itemx notext
1488@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1489Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1490or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1491report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1492
97a232d7
NC
1493@item undefs
1494Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1495either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1496This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1497
b0ab0693 1498@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1499@item x86-64-v2
1500@item x86-64-v3
1501@itemx x86-64-v4
1502Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1503@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1504@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1505@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1506@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1507Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1508
cd6d6c15
NC
1509@end table
1510
ece2d90e 1511Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1512
1513@kindex -(
1514@cindex groups of archives
1515@item -( @var{archives} -)
1516@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1517The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1518either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1519
1520The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1521references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1522the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1523archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1524object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1525would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1526they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1527resolved.
1528
1529Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1530it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1531more archives.
1532
69da35b5
NC
1533@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1534@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1535@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1536@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1537Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1538recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1539and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1540the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1541behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1542so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1543restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1544
4a43e768
AM
1545@kindex --as-needed
1546@kindex --no-as-needed
1547@item --as-needed
1548@itemx --no-as-needed
1549This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1550on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1551the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1552on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1553needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1554emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1555non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1556the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1557non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1558Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1559the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1560needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1561from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1562
6418520e
NC
1563Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1564an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1565@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1566@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1567
e56f61be
L
1568@kindex --add-needed
1569@kindex --no-add-needed
1570@item --add-needed
1571@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1572These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1573their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1574options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1575and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1576
252b5132
RH
1577@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1578@item -assert @var{keyword}
1579This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1580
1581@kindex -Bdynamic
1582@kindex -dy
1583@kindex -call_shared
1584@item -Bdynamic
1585@itemx -dy
1586@itemx -call_shared
1587Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1588for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1589default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1590for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1591multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1592@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1593
a1ab1d2a
UD
1594@kindex -Bgroup
1595@item -Bgroup
1596Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1597section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1598object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1599@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1600only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1601
252b5132
RH
1602@kindex -Bstatic
1603@kindex -dn
1604@kindex -non_shared
1605@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1606@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1607@itemx -dn
1608@itemx -non_shared
1609@itemx -static
1610Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1611platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1612variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1613may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1614library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1615option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1616option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1617shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1618references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1619libraries.
252b5132
RH
1620
1621@kindex -Bsymbolic
1622@item -Bsymbolic
1623When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1624definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1625for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1626within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1627platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1628
40b36307
L
1629@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1630@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1631When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1632symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1633This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1634libraries.
40b36307 1635
55255dae
L
1636@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1637@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1638Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1639typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1640global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1641within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1642to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1643in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1644which support shared libraries.
1645
1646The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1647scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1648
40b36307
L
1649@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1650@item --dynamic-list-data
1651Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1652
1653@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1654@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1655Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1656is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1657
0b8a70d9
L
1658@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1659@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1660Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1661
252b5132
RH
1662@kindex --check-sections
1663@kindex --no-check-sections
1664@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1665@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1666Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1667been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1668perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1669suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1670allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1671restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1672Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1673force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1674option.
252b5132 1675
ddbb8a31
NC
1676@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1677@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1678@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1679@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1680This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1681by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1682command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1683output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1684input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1685specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1686follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1687behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1688
1689This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1690libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1691mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1692their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1693required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1694the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1695dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1696symbols.
1697
252b5132
RH
1698@cindex cross reference table
1699@kindex --cref
1700@item --cref
1701Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1702generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1703Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1704
1705The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1706easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1707sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1708symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1709definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1710where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1711symbol are listed.
252b5132 1712
5dba6f05
NA
1713@cindex ctf variables
1714@kindex --ctf-variables
1715@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1716@item --ctf-variables
1717@item --no-ctf-variables
1718The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1719types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1720table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1721conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1722usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1723@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1724The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1725
1726@cindex ctf type sharing
1727@kindex --ctf-share-types
1728@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1729Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1730
1731@table @samp
1732@item share-unconflicted
1733Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1734where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1735translation unit. This is the default.
1736
1737@item share-duplicated
1738Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1739dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1740dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1741always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1742larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1743large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1744consumer at runtime.
1745@end table
1746
4818e05f
AM
1747@cindex common allocation
1748@kindex --no-define-common
1749@item --no-define-common
1750This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1751The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1752@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1753
1754The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1755the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1756of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1757forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1758Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1759from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1760This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1761and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1762duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1763paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1764
7bdf4127
AB
1765@cindex group allocation in linker script
1766@cindex section groups
1767@cindex COMDAT
1768@kindex --force-group-allocation
1769@item --force-group-allocation
1770This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1771normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1772default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1773change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1774command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1775effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1776
252b5132 1777@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1778@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1779@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1780Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1781address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1782times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1783limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1784context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1785symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1786constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1787using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1788@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1789equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1790
54874444
AB
1791The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1792in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1793symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1794placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1795the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1796consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1797@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1798you are trying to achieve.
1799
252b5132 1800@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1801@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1802@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1803@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1804@itemx --no-demangle
1805These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1806and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1807present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1808underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1809mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1810different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1811to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1812demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1813is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1814
1815@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1816@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1817@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1818@item -I@var{file}
1819@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1820Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1821generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1822linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1823doing.
1824
9b8b325a
RF
1825@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1826@item --no-dynamic-linker
1827When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1828linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1829executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1830entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1831
a70f34c0
NC
1832@kindex --embedded-relocs
1833@item --embedded-relocs
1834This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1835that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1836is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1837targets.
1838
3f0a5f17
ME
1839@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1840@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1841Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1842in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1843
7ce691ae 1844@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1845@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1846@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1847@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1848Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1849with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1850
252b5132
RH
1851@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1852@item --force-exe-suffix
1853Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1854
1855If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1856@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1857the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1858option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1859Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1860it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1861
1862@kindex --gc-sections
1863@kindex --no-gc-sections
1864@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1865@item --gc-sections
1866@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1867Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1868targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1869performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1870@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1871collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1872implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1873
d5465ba2
AM
1874@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1875examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1876symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1877command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1878referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1879libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1880referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1881the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1882relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1883@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1884
ac69cbc6 1885This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1886@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1887specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1888@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1889command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1890
99fabbc9
JL
1891As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1892@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1893
c17d87de
NC
1894@kindex --print-gc-sections
1895@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1896@cindex garbage collection
1897@item --print-gc-sections
1898@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1899List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1900printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1901collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1902default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1903be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1904line.
1905
22185505 1906@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1907@cindex garbage collection
1908@item --gc-keep-exported
1909When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1910collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1911default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1912executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1913collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1914Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1915it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1916ELF format targets.
1917
30824704
RM
1918@kindex --print-output-format
1919@cindex output format
1920@item --print-output-format
1921Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1922other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1923in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1924
3604cb1f
TG
1925@kindex --print-memory-usage
1926@cindex memory usage
1927@item --print-memory-usage
1928Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1929the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1930quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1931headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1932parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1933
1934@smallexample
1935Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1936 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1937 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1938@end smallexample
1939
252b5132
RH
1940@cindex help
1941@cindex usage
1942@kindex --help
1943@item --help
1944Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1945
ea20a7da
CC
1946@kindex --target-help
1947@item --target-help
a094d01f 1948Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1949
2509a395
SL
1950@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1951@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1952Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1953@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1954@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1955
1956Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1957written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1958inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1959file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1960@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1961output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1962@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1963
1964@smallexample
1965 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1966 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1967 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1968 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1969 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1970 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1971 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1972 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1973 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1974 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1975@end smallexample
1976
1977It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1978
1979If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1980operation.
252b5132
RH
1981
1982@cindex memory usage
1983@kindex --no-keep-memory
1984@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1985@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1986symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1987instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1988necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1989while linking a large executable.
1990
1991@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1992@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1993@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1994@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1995@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1996Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1997is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1998The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1999behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2000libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2001
97a232d7
NC
2002The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2003
aa713662
L
2004@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2005@kindex -z muldefs
2006@item --allow-multiple-definition
2007@itemx -z muldefs
2008Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2009report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2010first definition will be used.
2011
b79e8c78 2012@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2013@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2014@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2015@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2016Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2017This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2018determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2019shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2020how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2021
903249d7
NC
2022The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2023referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2024an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2025a shared library.
2026
2027The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2028libraries specified at link time are that:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item
2032A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2033that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2034resolvable at load time.
2035@item
2036There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2037symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2038
2039The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2040select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2041architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2042appropriate memset function.
2043@end itemize
b79e8c78 2044
23ae20f5
NC
2045@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2046@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2047If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2048@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2049only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2050libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2051``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2052undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2053will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2054might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2055error message will be displayed.
2056
2057The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2058switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2059
31941635
L
2060@kindex --no-undefined-version
2061@item --no-undefined-version
2062Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2063it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2064will be issued instead.
2065
3e3b46e5
PB
2066@kindex --default-symver
2067@item --default-symver
2068Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2069exported symbols.
2070
2071@kindex --default-imported-symver
2072@item --default-imported-symver
2073Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2074imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2075
252b5132
RH
2076@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2077@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2078Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2079files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2080been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2081This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2082errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2083have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2084inappropriate.
2085
fe7929ce
AM
2086@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2087@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2088Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2089library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2090
252b5132
RH
2091@kindex --no-whole-archive
2092@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2093Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2094archive files.
2095
2096@cindex output file after errors
2097@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2098@item --noinhibit-exec
2099Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2100Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2101errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2102when it issues any error whatsoever.
2103
0a9c1c8e
CD
2104@kindex -nostdlib
2105@item -nostdlib
2106Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2107command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2108(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2109
252b5132 2110@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2111@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2112@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2113@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2114file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2115@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2116object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2117object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2118should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2119usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2120name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2121list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2122command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2123this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2124@end ifclear
2125
76359541
TP
2126@kindex --out-implib
2127@item --out-implib @var{file}
2128Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2129the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2130library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2131may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2132behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2133step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2134the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2135
36af4a4e
JJ
2136@kindex -pie
2137@kindex --pic-executable
2138@item -pie
2139@itemx --pic-executable
2140@cindex position independent executables
2141Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2142ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2143libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2144address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2145normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2146defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2147
252b5132
RH
2148@kindex -qmagic
2149@item -qmagic
2150This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2151
2152@kindex -Qy
2153@item -Qy
2154This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2155
2156@kindex --relax
2157@cindex synthesizing linker
2158@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2159@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2160@item --relax
28d5f677 2161@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2162An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2163@ifset GENERIC
2164This option is only supported on a few targets.
2165@end ifset
2166@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2167@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2168@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2169@ifset XTENSA
2170@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2171@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2172@ifset M68HC11
2173@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2174@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2175@ifset NIOSII
2176@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2177@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2178@ifset POWERPC
2179@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2180@end ifset
252b5132 2181
ccd9fae5 2182On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2183global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2184addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2185synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2186instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2187
2188On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2189debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2190@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2191This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2192family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2193@end ifset
2194
ccd9fae5
NC
2195On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2196@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2197
ccd9fae5
NC
2198On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2199and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2200
252b5132
RH
2201@cindex retaining specified symbols
2202@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2203@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2204@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2205@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2206Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2207discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2208symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2209@ifset GENERIC
2210(such as VxWorks)
2211@end ifset
2212where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2213run-time memory.
2214
2215@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2216or symbols needed for relocations.
2217
2218You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2219line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2220
2221@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2222@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2223@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2224@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2225Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2226linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2227arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2228them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2229
2230The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2231are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2232description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2233in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2234have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2235
2236If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2237contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2238is defined.
252b5132 2239
ff5dcc92 2240The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2241SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2242@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2243runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2244options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2245gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2246file systems.
252b5132 2247
ff5dcc92 2248For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2249followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2250the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2251@end ifset
2252
2253@ifset GENERIC
2254@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2255@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2256@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2257When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2258happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2259of the input files.
2260
2261When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2262non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2263shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2264explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2265specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2266@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2267either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2268appearing multiple times.
2269
e680a6b6
NC
2270The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2271directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2272containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2273and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
227464-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2275
2276The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2277@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2278supported.
2279
28c309a2
NC
2280This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2281that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2282is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2283runtime linker would do.
2284
252b5132 2285The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2286libraries:
d8e4137b 2287
252b5132
RH
2288@enumerate
2289@item
ff5dcc92 2290Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2291@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2292Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2293between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2294specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2295used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2296at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2297by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2298the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2299@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2300On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2301@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2302environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2303@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2304On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2305directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2306@item
a1b8d843 2307For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2308variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2309@item
ec4eb78a
L
2310For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2311@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2312libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2313@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2314@item
252b5132
RH
2315The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2316@item
d8e4137b
NC
2317For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2318exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2319to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2320defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2321configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2322@item
2323For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2324the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2325header file.
2326@item
2327Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2328linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2329@end enumerate
2330
6418520e
NC
2331Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2332the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2333is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2334library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2335@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2336directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2337this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2338@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2339of the first.
2340
252b5132
RH
2341If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2342warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2343
252b5132
RH
2344@end ifset
2345
2346@kindex -shared
2347@kindex -Bshareable
2348@item -shared
2349@itemx -Bshareable
2350@cindex shared libraries
2351Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2352and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2353shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2354undefined symbols in the link.
2355
252b5132 2356@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2357@item --sort-common
2358@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2359@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2360This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2361ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2362sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2363eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2364between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2365specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2366
2509a395
SL
2367@kindex --sort-section=name
2368@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2369This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2370patterns in the linker script.
2371
2509a395
SL
2372@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2373@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2374This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2375patterns in the linker script.
2376
a70f34c0
NC
2377@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2378@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2379This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2380.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2381post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2382
252b5132 2383@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2384@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2385Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2386each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2387size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2388
2389@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2390@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2391Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2392output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2393This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2394certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2395cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2396that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2397support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2398input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2399more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2400many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2401
2402@kindex --stats
2403@item --stats
2404Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2405as execution time and memory usage.
2406
2509a395 2407@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2408@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2409Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2410configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2411that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2412
a70f34c0
NC
2413@kindex --task-link
2414@item --task-link
2415This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2416file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2417
252b5132
RH
2418@kindex --traditional-format
2419@cindex traditional format
2420@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2421For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2422the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2423use the traditional format instead.
2424
2425@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2426For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2427symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2428full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2429@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2430trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2431combine duplicate entries.
2432
2509a395
SL
2433@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2434@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2435Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2436address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2437times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2438line.
2439@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2440for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2441@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2442should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2443sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2444
2509a395
SL
2445@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2446@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2447@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2448@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2449@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2450@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2451@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2452Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2453@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2454
2509a395
SL
2455@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2456@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2457@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2458When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2459byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2460
9d5777a3
RM
2461@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2462@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2463@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2464When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2465the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2466text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2467
0d705e9f
AM
2468@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2469@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2470@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2471When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2472model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2473
560e09e9
NC
2474@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2475@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2476Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2477values for @samp{method}:
2478
2479@table @samp
2480@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2481Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2482
2483@item report-all
da8bce14 2484Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2485
2486@item ignore-in-object-files
2487Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2488ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2489
2490@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2491Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2492ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2493when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2494libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2495command line.
2496@end table
2497
2498The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2499by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2500
2501Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2502unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2503can change this to a warning.
2504
1715a13c
L
2505@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2506@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2507@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2508@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2509Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2510supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2511the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2512argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2513
2514@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2515@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2516@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2517Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2518used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2519about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2520is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2521see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2522use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2523symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2524@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2525
7ce691ae 2526@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2527@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2528@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2529@item --warn-common
2530Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2531a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2532but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2533you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2534Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2535warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2536
2537There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2538
2539@table @samp
2540@item int i = 1;
2541A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2542file.
2543
2544@item extern int i;
2545An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2546There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2547variable somewhere.
2548
2549@item int i;
2550A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2551variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2552The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2553single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2554size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2555a definition of the same variable.
2556@end table
2557
2558The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2559Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2560just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2561encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2562a common symbol.
2563
2564@enumerate
2565@item
2566Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2567definition for the symbol.
2568@smallexample
2569@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2570 overridden by definition
2571@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2572@end smallexample
2573
2574@item
2575Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2576the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2577except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2578@smallexample
2579@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2580 overriding common
2581@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2582@end smallexample
2583
2584@item
2585Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2586@smallexample
2587@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2588 of `@var{symbol}'
2589@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2590@end smallexample
2591
2592@item
2593Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2594@smallexample
2595@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2596 overridden by larger common
2597@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2598@end smallexample
2599
2600@item
2601Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2602the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2603encountered in a different order.
2604@smallexample
2605@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2606 overriding smaller common
2607@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2608@end smallexample
2609@end enumerate
2610
2611@kindex --warn-constructors
2612@item --warn-constructors
2613Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2614object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2615detect the use of global constructors.
2616
2617@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2618@item --warn-multiple-gp
2619Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2620This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2621Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2622section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2623of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2624base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2625base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2626bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2627large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2628values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2629option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2630
2631@kindex --warn-once
2632@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2633@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2634@item --warn-once
2635Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2636which refers to it.
2637
2638@kindex --warn-section-align
2639@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2640@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2641@item --warn-section-align
2642Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2643alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2644The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2645is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2646the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2647
a6dbf402
L
2648@kindex --warn-textrel
2649@item --warn-textrel
2650Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2651or shared object.
8fdd7217 2652
a0c402a5
L
2653@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2654@item --warn-alternate-em
2655Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2656
560e09e9
NC
2657@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2658@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2659If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2660@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2661This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2662
2663@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2664@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2665This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2666it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2667
252b5132
RH
2668@kindex --whole-archive
2669@cindex including an entire archive
2670@item --whole-archive
2671For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2672@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2673in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2674files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2675library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2676library. This option may be used more than once.
2677
7ec229ce 2678Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2679about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2680Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2681list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2682your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2683
2509a395
SL
2684@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2685@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2686Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2687@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2688undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2689@var{symbol}.
2690
2691This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2692wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2693wishes to call the system function, it should call
2694@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2695
2696Here is a trivial example:
2697
2698@smallexample
2699void *
cc2f008e 2700__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2701@{
cc2f008e 2702 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2703 return __real_malloc (c);
2704@}
2705@end smallexample
2706
ff5dcc92 2707If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2708all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2709instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2710call the real @code{malloc} function.
2711
2712You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2713links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2714you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2715file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2716call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2717
4ea904ed
SH
2718Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2719internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2720@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2721@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2722
2723@smallexample
2724int
2725f (void)
2726@{
2727 return 123;
2728@}
2729
2730int
2731g (void)
2732@{
2733 return f();
2734@}
2735@end smallexample
2736
6aa29e7b 2737@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2738@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2739@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2740@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2741Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2742(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2743section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2744
e41b3a13
JJ
2745@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2746@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2747Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2748generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2749if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2750
6c1439be
L
2751@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2752@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2753@item --enable-new-dtags
2754@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2755This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2756systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2757@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2758and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2759If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2760created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2761those options are only available for ELF systems.
2762
2d643429 2763@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2764@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2765Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2766close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2767time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2768increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2769value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2770
fdc90cb4
JJ
2771@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2772@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2773Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2774@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2775new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2776the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2777hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2778but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2779
0ce398f1
L
2780@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2781@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2782@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2783@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2784@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2785@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2786@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2787@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2788On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2789compressed using zlib.
2790
2791@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2792sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2793DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2794instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2795also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2796sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2797
2798The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2799@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2800
2801Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2802sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2803for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2804uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2805
2806The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2807involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2808default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2809@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2810
35835446
JR
2811@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2812@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2813This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2814linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2815for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2816about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2817
4f9c04f7 2818Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28191021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2820run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2821has been used.
2822
2823The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2824enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2825
c0065db7
RM
2826@kindex --build-id
2827@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2828@item --build-id
2829@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2830Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2831or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2832unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2833@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2834@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2835@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2836the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2837string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2838@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2839is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2840
2841The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2842that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2843unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2844to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2845file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2846string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2847
2848Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2849@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2850@end table
2851
0285c67d
NC
2852@c man end
2853
36f63dca 2854@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2855
0285c67d
NC
2856@c man begin OPTIONS
2857
ff5dcc92 2858The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2859the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2860normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2861use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2862@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2863like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2864symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2865object file).
2866
2867In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2868support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2869PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2870values by either a space or an equals sign.
2871
ff5dcc92 2872@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2873
2874@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2875@item --add-stdcall-alias
2876If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2877as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2878[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2879
2880@kindex --base-file
2881@item --base-file @var{file}
2882Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2883addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2884@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2885[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2886
2887@kindex --dll
2888@item --dll
2889Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2890@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2891file.
bb10df36 2892[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2893
88183869
DK
2894@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2895@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2896@item --enable-long-section-names
2897@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2898The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2899the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2900for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2901fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2902to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2903allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2904disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2905generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2906as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2907with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2908GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2909information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2910option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2911section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2912when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2913image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2914[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2915
252b5132
RH
2916@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2917@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2918@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2919@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2920If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2921do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2922only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2923resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2924undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2925@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2926to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2927warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2928import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2929to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2930feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2931@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2932mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2933[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2934
522f09cd
KT
2935@kindex --leading-underscore
2936@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2937@item --leading-underscore
2938@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2939For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2940in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2941disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2942
252b5132
RH
2943@cindex DLLs, creating
2944@kindex --export-all-symbols
2945@item --export-all-symbols
2946If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2947be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2948otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2949explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2950attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2951option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2952@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2953@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2954exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2955re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2956such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2957@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2958@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2959Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2960not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2961extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2962(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2963These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2964@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2965@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2966@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2967@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2968[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2969
2970@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2971@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2972Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2973exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2974[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2975
2927aaca
NC
2976@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2977@item --exclude-all-symbols
2978Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2979[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2980
252b5132
RH
2981@kindex --file-alignment
2982@item --file-alignment
2983Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2984file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2985512.
bb10df36 2986[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2987
2988@cindex heap size
2989@kindex --heap
2990@item --heap @var{reserve}
2991@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2992Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2993to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2994committed.
bb10df36 2995[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2996
2997@cindex image base
2998@kindex --image-base
2999@item --image-base @var{value}
3000Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3001the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3002is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3003your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3004other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3005for dlls.
bb10df36 3006[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3007
3008@kindex --kill-at
3009@item --kill-at
3010If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3011symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3012[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3013
26d2d8a2
BF
3014@kindex --large-address-aware
3015@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3016If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3017header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3018greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3019or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3020section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3021[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3022
f69a2f97
NC
3023@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3024@item --disable-large-address-aware
3025Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3026This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3027driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3028addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3029[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3030
252b5132
RH
3031@kindex --major-image-version
3032@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3033Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3034[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3035
3036@kindex --major-os-version
3037@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3038Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3039[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3040
3041@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3042@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3043Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3044[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3045
3046@kindex --minor-image-version
3047@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3048Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3049[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3050
3051@kindex --minor-os-version
3052@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3053Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3054[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3055
3056@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3057@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3058Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3059[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3060
3061@cindex DEF files, creating
3062@cindex DLLs, creating
3063@kindex --output-def
3064@item --output-def @var{file}
3065The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3066file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3067(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3068library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3069automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3070[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3071
b044cda1 3072@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3073@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3074@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3075@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3076Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3077@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3078By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3079for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3080execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3081[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3082
3083@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3084@item --disable-auto-image-base
3085Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3086user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3087default.
bb10df36 3088[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3089
3090@cindex DLLs, linking to
3091@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3092@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3093When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3094search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3095@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3096between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3097uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3098@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3099[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3100
3101@kindex --enable-auto-import
3102@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3103Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3104DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3105mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3106[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3107
3108The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3109feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3110
3111Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3112of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3113PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3114
e2a83dd0
NC
3115Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3116data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3117placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3118around a problem with consts that is described here:
3119http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3120
4d8907ac
DS
3121Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3122see this message:
0d888aac 3123
ece2d90e 3124"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3125documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3126
ece2d90e
NC
3127This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3128ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3129allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3130fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3131constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3132multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3133this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3134of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3135the warning, and exit.
3136
3137There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3138data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3139
2fa9fc65
NC
3140One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3141of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3142this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3143
c0065db7
RM
3144A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3145that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3146there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3147a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3148
3149@example
3150extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3151extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3152 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3153@end example
3154
3155or
3156
3157@example
3158extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3159extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3160 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3161@end example
3162
c0065db7 3163For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3164is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3165
3166@example
3167extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3168extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3169 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3170@end example
3171
c406afaf
NC
3172or
3173
3174@example
3175extern long long extern_ll;
3176extern_ll -->
3177 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3178@end example
3179
2fa9fc65 3180A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3181'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3182@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3183requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3184building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3185merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3186between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3187constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3188
3189Original:
3190@example
3191--foo.h
3192extern int arr[];
3193--foo.c
3194#include "foo.h"
3195void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3196 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3197@}
3198@end example
3199
3200Solution 1:
3201@example
3202--foo.h
3203extern int arr[];
3204--foo.c
3205#include "foo.h"
3206void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3207 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3208 volatile int *parr = arr;
3209 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3210@}
3211@end example
3212
3213Solution 2:
3214@example
3215--foo.h
3216/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3217#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3218 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3219#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3220#else
3221#define FOO_IMPORT
3222#endif
3223extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3224--foo.c
3225#include "foo.h"
3226void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3227 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3228@}
3229@end example
3230
c0065db7 3231A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3232library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3233for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3234functions).
b044cda1
CW
3235
3236@kindex --disable-auto-import
3237@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3238Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3239@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3240[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3241
2fa9fc65
NC
3242@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3243@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3244If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3245that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3246a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3247environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3248[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3249
3250@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3251@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3252Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3253[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3254
b044cda1
CW
3255@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3256@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3257Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3258[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3259
252b5132
RH
3260@kindex --section-alignment
3261@item --section-alignment
3262Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3263addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3264[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3265
3266@cindex stack size
3267@kindex --stack
3268@item --stack @var{reserve}
3269@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3270Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3271to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3272committed.
bb10df36 3273[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3274
3275@kindex --subsystem
3276@item --subsystem @var{which}
3277@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3278@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3279Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3280legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3281@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3282the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3283@var{which}.
bb10df36 3284[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3285
2f563b51
DK
3286The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3287of the PE file header:
3288[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3289
2d5c3743
NC
3290@kindex --high-entropy-va
3291@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3292@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3293Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3294(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3295
dc9bd8c9
HD
3296This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3297@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3298
2f563b51
DK
3299@kindex --dynamicbase
3300@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3301@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3302The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3303randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3304Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3305can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3306This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3307
3308@kindex --forceinteg
3309@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3310@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3311Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3312default.
2f563b51
DK
3313
3314@kindex --nxcompat
3315@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3316@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3317The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3318This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3319targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3320
3321@kindex --no-isolation
3322@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3323@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3324Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3325This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3326
3327@kindex --no-seh
3328@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3329@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3330The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3331this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3332
3333@kindex --no-bind
3334@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3335@itemx --disable-no-bind
3336Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3337
3338@kindex --wdmdriver
3339@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3340@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3341The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3342by default.
9d5777a3 3343
2f563b51
DK
3344@kindex --tsaware
3345@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3346@itemx --disable-tsaware
3347The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3348default.
2f563b51 3349
0cb112f7
CF
3350@kindex --insert-timestamp
3351@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3352@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3353Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3354as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3355other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3356will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3357same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3358can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3359that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3360identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3361
3362@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3363@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3364@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3365Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3366is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3367This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3368@end table
3369
0285c67d
NC
3370@c man end
3371
ac145307
BS
3372@ifset C6X
3373@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3374
3375@c man begin OPTIONS
3376
3377The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3378libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3379all executables use an index of 0.
3380
3381@table @gcctabopt
3382
3383@kindex --dsbt-size
3384@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3385This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3386or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3387entries.
3388
3389@kindex --dsbt-index
3390@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3391This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3392to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3393executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3394@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3395
fbd9ad90
PB
3396@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3397The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3398exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3399
ac145307
BS
3400@end table
3401
3402@c man end
3403@end ifset
3404
b8891f8d
AJ
3405@ifset CSKY
3406@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3407
3408@c man begin OPTIONS
3409
3410@table @gcctabopt
3411
3412@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3413@item --branch-stub
3414This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3415sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3416usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3417can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3418the compiler or assembler.
3419
3420@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3421@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3422This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3423It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3424be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3425stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3426sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3427@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3428linker should choose suitable defaults.
3429
3430@end table
3431
3432@c man end
3433@end ifset
3434
93fd0973
SC
3435@ifset M68HC11
3436@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3437
3438@c man begin OPTIONS
3439
3440The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3441memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3442
3443@table @gcctabopt
3444
3445@kindex --no-trampoline
3446@item --no-trampoline
3447This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3448is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3449instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3450
3451@kindex --bank-window
3452@item --bank-window @var{name}
3453This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3454the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3455The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3456paging and addresses within the memory window.
3457
3458@end table
3459
3460@c man end
3461@end ifset
3462
7fb9f789
NC
3463@ifset M68K
3464@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3465
3466@c man begin OPTIONS
3467
3468The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3469when linking for 68K targets.
3470
3471@table @gcctabopt
3472
3473@kindex --got
3474@item --got=@var{type}
3475This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3476@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3477@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3478Info entry for @file{ld}.
3479
3480@end table
3481
3482@c man end
3483@end ifset
3484
833794fc
MR
3485@ifset MIPS
3486@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3487
3488@c man begin OPTIONS
3489
3490The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3491generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3492linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3493
3494@table @gcctabopt
3495
3496@kindex --insn32
3497@item --insn32
3498@kindex --no-insn32
3499@itemx --no-insn32
3500These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3501generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3502or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
350332-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3504used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3505possible.
3506
8b10b0b3
MR
3507@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3508@item --ignore-branch-isa
3509@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3510@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3511These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3512transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3513accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3514is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3515instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3516equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3517calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3518a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3519an error.
3520
3734320d
MF
3521@kindex --compact-branches
3522@item --compact-branches
3523@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3524@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3525These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3526in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3527
833794fc
MR
3528@end table
3529
3530@c man end
3531@end ifset
3532
fa1477dc
SC
3533
3534@ifset PDP11
3535@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3536
3537@c man begin OPTIONS
3538
3539For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3540produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3541for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3542targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3543defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3544here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3545
3546@table @gcctabopt
3547
3548@kindex -N
3549@item -N
3550@kindex --omagic
3551@itemx --omagic
3552
3553Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3554indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3555shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3556writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3557the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3558programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3559from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3560
3561@kindex -n
3562@item -n
3563@kindex --nmagic
3564@itemx --nmagic
3565
3566Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3567indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3568be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3569file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3570byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3571a @emph{pure executable} format.
3572
3573@kindex -z
3574@item -z
3575@kindex --imagic
3576@itemx --imagic
3577
3578Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3579indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3580data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3581instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3582larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3583to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3584shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3585option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3586and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3587this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3588executable} format.
3589
3590@kindex --no-omagic
3591@item --no-omagic
3592
3593Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3594
3595@end table
3596
3597@c man end
3598@end ifset
3599
252b5132
RH
3600@ifset UsesEnvVars
3601@node Environment
3602@section Environment Variables
3603
0285c67d
NC
3604@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3605
560e09e9 3606You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3607@ifclear SingleFormat
3608@code{GNUTARGET},
3609@end ifclear
3610@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3611
36f63dca 3612@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3613@kindex GNUTARGET
3614@cindex default input format
3615@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3616use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3617of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3618@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3619of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3620attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3621this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3622there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3623object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3624BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3625in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3626@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3627
3628@kindex LDEMULATION
3629@cindex default emulation
3630@cindex emulation, default
3631@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3632@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3633behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3634available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3635the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3636variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3637linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3638
3639@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3640@cindex demangling, default
3641Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3642@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3643default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3644a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3645may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3646options.
3647
0285c67d
NC
3648@c man end
3649@end ifset
3650
252b5132
RH
3651@node Scripts
3652@chapter Linker Scripts
3653
3654@cindex scripts
3655@cindex linker scripts
3656@cindex command files
3657Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3658written in the linker command language.
3659
3660The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3661the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3662the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3663more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3664direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3665described below.
3666
3667The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3668yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3669linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3670to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3671such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3672
3673You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3674line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3675default linker script.
3676
3677You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3678to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3679Linker Scripts}.
3680
3681@menu
3682* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3683* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3684* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3685* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3686* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3687* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3688* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3689* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3690* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3691* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3692* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3693@end menu
3694
3695@node Basic Script Concepts
3696@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3697@cindex linker script concepts
3698We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3699describe the linker script language.
3700
3701The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3702file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3703@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3704The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3705purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3706among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3707section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3708in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3709
3710Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3711also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3712contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3713the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3714A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3715area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3716loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3717which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3718of debugging information.
3719
3720Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3721first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3722the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3723@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3724section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3725same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3726is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3727(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3728based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3729RAM address would be the VMA.
3730
3731You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3732program with the @samp{-h} option.
3733
3734Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3735@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3736has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3737information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3738will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3739static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3740referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3741
3742You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3743program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3744option.
3745
3746@node Script Format
3747@section Linker Script Format
3748@cindex linker script format
3749Linker scripts are text files.
3750
3751You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3752either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3753symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3754generally ignored.
3755
3756Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3757If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3758otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3759double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3760file name.
3761
3762You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3763@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3764to whitespace.
3765
3766@node Simple Example
3767@section Simple Linker Script Example
3768@cindex linker script example
3769@cindex example of linker script
3770Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3771
3772The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3773@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3774memory layout of the output file.
3775
3776The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3777describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3778code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3779@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3780Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3781your input files.
3782
3783For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37840x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3785linker script which will do that:
3786@smallexample
3787SECTIONS
3788@{
3789 . = 0x10000;
3790 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3791 . = 0x8000000;
3792 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3793 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3794@}
3795@end smallexample
3796
3797You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3798followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3799descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3800
252b5132
RH
3801The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3802sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3803counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3804other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3805current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3806incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3807@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3808
3809The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3810required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3811after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3812which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3813wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3814means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3815
3816Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3817@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3818@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3819
3820The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3821the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3822at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3823output section, the value of the location counter will be
3824@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3825effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3826immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3827
3828The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3829alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3830example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3831sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3832may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3833sections.
3834
3835That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3836
3837@node Simple Commands
3838@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3839@cindex linker script simple commands
3840In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3841
3842@menu
3843* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3844* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3845@ifclear SingleFormat
3846* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3847@end ifclear
3848
4a93e180 3849* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3850* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3851@end menu
3852
3853@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3854@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3855@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3856@cindex start of execution
3857@cindex first instruction
3858@cindex entry point
3859The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3860point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3861entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3862@smallexample
3863ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3864@end smallexample
3865
3866There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3867entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3868stopping when one of them succeeds:
3869@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3870@item
252b5132 3871the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3872@item
252b5132 3873the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3874@item
a094d01f 3875the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3876targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3877check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3878@item
252b5132 3879the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3880@item
252b5132
RH
3881The address @code{0}.
3882@end itemize
3883
3884@node File Commands
36f63dca 3885@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3886@cindex linker script file commands
3887Several linker script commands deal with files.
3888
3889@table @code
3890@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3891@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3892@cindex including a linker script
3893Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3894be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3895with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
389610 levels deep.
3897
4006703d
NS
3898You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3899@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3900
252b5132
RH
3901@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3902@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3903@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3904@cindex input files in linker scripts
3905@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3906@cindex linker script input object files
3907The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3908in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3909
3910For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3911a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3912then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3913
3914In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3915script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3916
e3f2db7f
AO
3917In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3918with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3919located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3920for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3921@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3922filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3923@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3924
3925If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3926the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3927found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3928not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3929path.
252b5132 3930
ff5dcc92 3931If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3932name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3933@samp{-l}.
3934
3935When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3936files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3937script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3938
3939@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3940@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3941@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3942@cindex grouping input files
3943The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3944files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3945new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3946in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3947
b717d30e
JJ
3948@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3949@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3950@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3951This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3952commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3953as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3954with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3955when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3956@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3957and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3958setting afterwards.
3959
252b5132
RH
3960@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3961@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3962@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3963The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3964@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3965@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3966Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3967precedence.
3968
3969You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3970output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3971
3972@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3973@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3974@cindex library search path in linker script
3975@cindex archive search path in linker script
3976@cindex search path in linker script
3977The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3978@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3979@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3980on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3981are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3982the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3983
3984@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3985@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3986@cindex first input file
3987The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3988that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3989though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3990when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3991first file.
3992@end table
3993
3994@ifclear SingleFormat
3995@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3996@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3997A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3998
3999@table @code
4000@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4001@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4002@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4003@cindex output file format in linker script
4004The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4005output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4006exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4007(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4008line option takes precedence.
4009
4010You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4011formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4012This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4013desired endianness.
4014
4015If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4016will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4017output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4018used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4019
4020For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4021command:
4022@smallexample
4023OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4024@end smallexample
4025This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4026@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4027option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4028format.
4029
4030@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4031@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4032@cindex input file format in linker script
4033The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4034files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4035This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4036(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4037is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4038command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4039@end table
4040@end ifclear
4041
4a93e180
NC
4042@node REGION_ALIAS
4043@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4044@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4045@cindex region alias
4046@cindex region names
4047
4048Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4049@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4050
4051@smallexample
4052REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4053@end smallexample
4054
4055The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4056memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4057to memory regions. An example follows.
4058
4059Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4060memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4061that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4062non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4063access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4064read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4065sections:
4066
4067@itemize @bullet
4068@item
4069@code{.text} program code;
4070@item
4071@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4072@item
4073@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4074@item
4075@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4076@end itemize
4077
4078The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4079part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4080output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4081systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4082@code{C}:
4083@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4084@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4085@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4086@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4087@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4088@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4089@end multitable
4090The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4091loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4092the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4093the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4094
4095The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4096includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4097memory layout:
4098@smallexample
4099INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4100
4101SECTIONS
4102 @{
4103 .text :
4104 @{
4105 *(.text)
4106 @} > REGION_TEXT
4107 .rodata :
4108 @{
4109 *(.rodata)
4110 rodata_end = .;
4111 @} > REGION_RODATA
4112 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4113 @{
4114 data_start = .;
4115 *(.data)
4116 @} > REGION_DATA
4117 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4118 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4119 .bss :
4120 @{
4121 *(.bss)
4122 @} > REGION_BSS
4123 @}
4124@end smallexample
4125
4126Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4127regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4128variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4129@table @code
4130@item A
4131Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4132@smallexample
4133MEMORY
4134 @{
4135 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4136 @}
4137
4138REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4139REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4140REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4141REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4142@end smallexample
4143@item B
4144Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4145into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4146@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4147@smallexample
4148MEMORY
4149 @{
4150 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4151 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4152 @}
4153
4154REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4155REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4156REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4157REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4158@end smallexample
4159@item C
4160Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4161@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4162initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4163system start into the @code{RAM}.
4164@smallexample
4165MEMORY
4166 @{
4167 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4168 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4169 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4170 @}
4171
4172REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4173REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4174REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4175REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4176@end smallexample
4177@end table
4178
4179It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4180@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4181necessary:
4182@smallexample
4183#include <string.h>
4184
4185extern char data_start [];
4186extern char data_size [];
4187extern char data_load_start [];
4188
4189void copy_data(void)
4190@{
4191 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4192 @{
4193 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4194 @}
4195@}
4196@end smallexample
4197
252b5132 4198@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4199@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4200There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4201
4202@table @code
4203@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4204@kindex ASSERT
4205@cindex assertion in linker script
4206Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4207with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4208
fd1c4238
NC
4209Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4210take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4211inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4212for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4213symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4214
4215@smallexample
4216 .stack :
4217 @{
4218 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4219 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4220 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4221 @}
4222@end smallexample
4223
4224will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4225PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4226can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4227
4228@smallexample
4229 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4230 .stack :
4231 @{
4232 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4233 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4234 @}
4235@end smallexample
4236
4237will work.
4238
252b5132
RH
4239@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4240@kindex EXTERN
4241@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4242Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4243symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4244modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4245each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4246command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4247
4248@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4249@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4250@cindex common allocation in linker script
4251This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4252to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4253output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4254
4818e05f
AM
4255@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4256@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4257@cindex common allocation in linker script
4258This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4259command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4260to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4261
7bdf4127
AB
4262@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4263@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4264@cindex group allocation in linker script
4265@cindex section groups
4266@cindex COMDAT
4267This command has the same effect as the
4268@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4269@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4270and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4271specified (@samp{-r}).
4272
53d25da6
AM
4273@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4274@kindex INSERT
4275@cindex insert user script into default script
4276This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4277augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4278inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4279@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4280default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4281sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4282linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4283insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4284linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4285default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4286of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4287to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4288is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4289
4290@smallexample
4291SECTIONS
4292@{
4293 OVERLAY :
4294 @{
4295 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4296 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4297 @}
4298@}
4299INSERT AFTER .text;
4300@end smallexample
4301
252b5132
RH
4302@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4303@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4304@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4305This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4306references among certain output sections.
4307
4308In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4309using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4310will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4311errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4312a function defined in the other section.
4313
4314The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4315@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4316an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4317@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4318names.
4319
cdf96953
MF
4320@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4321@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4322@cindex cross references
4323This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4324references to one section from a list of other sections.
4325
4326The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4327output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4328a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4329there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4330must never call back.
4331
4332The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4333The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4334If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4335the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4336status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4337names, not input section names.
4338
252b5132
RH
4339@ifclear SingleFormat
4340@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4341@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4342@cindex machine architecture
4343@cindex architecture
4344Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4345of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4346architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4347the @samp{-f} option.
4348@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4349
4350@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4351@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4352This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4353@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4354in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4355@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4356@end table
4357
4358@node Assignments
4359@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4360@cindex assignment in scripts
4361@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4362@cindex variables, defining
4363You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4364the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4365
4366@menu
4367* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4368* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4369* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4370* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4371* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4372@end menu
4373
4374@node Simple Assignments
4375@subsection Simple Assignments
4376
4377You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4378
4379@table @code
4380@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4381@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4382@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4383@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4384@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4385@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4386@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4387@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4388@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4389@end table
4390
4391The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4392@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4393defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4394
4395The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4396may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4397
4398The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4399
4400Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4401
4402You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4403statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4404section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4405
4406The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4407expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4408
4409Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4410assignments may be used:
4411
4412@smallexample
4413floating_point = 0;
4414SECTIONS
4415@{
4416 .text :
4417 @{
4418 *(.text)
4419 _etext = .;
4420 @}
156e34dd 4421 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4422 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4423@}
4424@end smallexample
4425@noindent
4426In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4427zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4428the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4429defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4430upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4431
eb8476a6
MR
4432@node HIDDEN
4433@subsection HIDDEN
4434@cindex HIDDEN
4435For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4436exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4437
4438Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4439@code{HIDDEN}:
4440
4441@smallexample
4442HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4443SECTIONS
4444@{
4445 .text :
4446 @{
4447 *(.text)
4448 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4449 @}
4450 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4451 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4452@}
4453@end smallexample
4454@noindent
4455In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4456
252b5132
RH
4457@node PROVIDE
4458@subsection PROVIDE
4459@cindex PROVIDE
4460In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4461only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4462the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4463@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4464@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4465@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4466@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4467@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4468
4469Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4470@smallexample
4471SECTIONS
4472@{
4473 .text :
4474 @{
4475 *(.text)
4476 _etext = .;
4477 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4478 @}
4479@}
4480@end smallexample
4481
4482In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4483underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4484on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4485underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4486If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4487linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4488
b0daac83
NC
4489Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4490defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4491that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4492when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4493@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4494
7af8e998
L
4495@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4496@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4497@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4498Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4499hidden and won't be exported.
4500
73ae6183
NC
4501@node Source Code Reference
4502@subsection Source Code Reference
4503
4504Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4505intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4506a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4507symbol that does not have a value.
4508
4509Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4510transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4511stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4512prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4513mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4514of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4515variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4516linker script variable might be referred to as:
4517
4518@smallexample
4519 extern int foo;
4520@end smallexample
4521
4522But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4523
4524@smallexample
4525 _foo = 1000;
4526@end smallexample
4527
4528In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4529transformation has taken place.
4530
4531When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4532things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4533in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4534second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4535table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4536contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4537value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4538
4539@smallexample
4540 int foo = 1000;
4541@end smallexample
4542
10bf6894 4543creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4544holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4545number 1000 is initially stored.
4546
4547When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4548first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4549memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4550So:
4551
4552@smallexample
4553 foo = 1;
4554@end smallexample
4555
4556looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4557associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4558address. Whereas:
4559
4560@smallexample
4561 int * a = & foo;
4562@end smallexample
4563
10bf6894 4564looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4565and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4566the variable @samp{a}.
4567
4568Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4569the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4570an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4571
4572@smallexample
4573 foo = 1000;
4574@end smallexample
4575
4576creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4577the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4578address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4579linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4580access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4581
4582Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4583you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4584use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4585section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4586linker script contains these declarations:
4587
4588@smallexample
4589@group
4590 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4591 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4592 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4593@end group
4594@end smallexample
4595
4596Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4597
4598@smallexample
4599@group
4600 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4601
73ae6183
NC
4602 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4603@end group
4604@end smallexample
4605
4606Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4607Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4608arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4609
4610@smallexample
4611@group
4612 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4613
4614 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4615@end group
4616@end smallexample
4617
4618Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4619operators.
73ae6183 4620
252b5132 4621@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4622@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4623@kindex SECTIONS
4624The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4625into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4626
4627The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4628@smallexample
4629SECTIONS
4630@{
4631 @var{sections-command}
4632 @var{sections-command}
4633 @dots{}
4634@}
4635@end smallexample
4636
4637Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4638
4639@itemize @bullet
4640@item
4641an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4642@item
4643a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4644@item
4645an output section description
4646@item
4647an overlay description
4648@end itemize
4649
4650The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4651@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4652those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4653understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4654the layout of the output file.
4655
4656Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4657below.
4658
4659If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4660linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4661section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4662input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4663example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4664in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4665
4666@menu
4667* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4668* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4669* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4670* Input Section:: Input section description
4671* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4672* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4673* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4674* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4675* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4676@end menu
4677
4678@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4679@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4680The full description of an output section looks like this:
4681@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4682@group
7e7d5768 4683@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4684 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4685 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4686 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4687 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4688 @{
4689 @var{output-section-command}
4690 @var{output-section-command}
4691 @dots{}
abc9061b 4692 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4693@end group
4694@end smallexample
4695
4696Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4697
4698The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4699name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4700The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4701the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4702The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4703
4704Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4705
4706@itemize @bullet
4707@item
4708a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4709@item
4710an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4711@item
4712data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4713@item
4714a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4715@end itemize
4716
4717@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4718@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4719@cindex name, section
4720@cindex section name
4721The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4722meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4723support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4724must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4725example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4726output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4727names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4728quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4729characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4730commas must be quoted.
4731
4732The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4733Discarding}.
4734
4735@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4736@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4737@cindex address, section
4738@cindex section address
4739The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4740address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4741is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4742
4743If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4744section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4745to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4746alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4747contained within the output section.
4748
4749The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4750
4751@itemize @bullet
4752@item
4753If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4754is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4755in that region.
4756
4757@item
4758If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4759regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4760section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4761be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4762
4763@item
4764If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4765the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4766counter.
4767@end itemize
4768
4769@noindent
4770For example:
4771
252b5132
RH
4772@smallexample
4773.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4774@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4775
252b5132
RH
4776@noindent
4777and
ea5cae92 4778
252b5132
RH
4779@smallexample
4780.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4781@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4782
252b5132
RH
4783@noindent
4784are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4785@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4786counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4787counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4788input sections.
252b5132
RH
4789
4790The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4791For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4792so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4793do something like this:
4794@smallexample
4795.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4796@end smallexample
4797@noindent
4798This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4799aligned upward to the specified value.
4800
4801Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4802location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4803sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4804
4805@node Input Section
36f63dca 4806@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4807@cindex input sections
4808@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4809The most common output section command is an input section description.
4810
4811The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4812You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4813in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4814map the input files into your memory layout.
4815
4816@menu
4817* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4818* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4819* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4820* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4821* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4822@end menu
4823
4824@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4825@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4826@cindex input section basics
4827An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4828by a list of section names in parentheses.
4829
4830The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4831describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4832
4833The most common input section description is to include all input
4834sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4835include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4836@smallexample
4837*(.text)
4838@end smallexample
4839@noindent
18625d54 4840Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4841@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4842of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4843match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4844example:
252b5132 4845@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4846EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4847@end smallexample
4848@noindent
4849will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4850and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4851placed inside the section list, for example:
4852@smallexample
b4346c09 4853*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4854@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4855@noindent
4856The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4857two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4858more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4859
4860There are two ways to include more than one section:
4861@smallexample
4862*(.text .rdata)
4863*(.text) *(.rdata)
4864@end smallexample
4865@noindent
4866The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4867@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4868first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4869they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4870@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4871@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4872
8f1732fc
AB
4873When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4874is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4875immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4876@smallexample
4877*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4878@end smallexample
4879@noindent
4880will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4881@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4882from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4883exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4884could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4885@smallexample
4886*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4887@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4888@noindent
4889Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4890before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4891all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4892@smallexample
4893EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4894@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4895
252b5132
RH
4896You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4897You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4898needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4899@smallexample
4900data.o(.data)
4901@end smallexample
4902
ae17ab41
CM
4903To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4904of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4905
4906Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4907
4908@smallexample
4909@group
4910SECTIONS @{
4911 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4912 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4913@}
4914@end group
4915@end smallexample
4916
4917In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4918input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4919@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4920@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4921whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4922
967928e9
AM
4923You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4924matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4925with no whitespace around the colon.
4926
4927@table @samp
4928@item archive:file
4929matches file within archive
4930@item archive:
4931matches the whole archive
4932@item :file
4933matches file but not one in an archive
4934@end table
4935
4936Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4937wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4938single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4939@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4940within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4941also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4942other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4943from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4944command.
4945
252b5132
RH
4946If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4947the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4948commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4949@smallexample
4950data.o
4951@end smallexample
4952
967928e9
AM
4953When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4954and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4955characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4956name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4957did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4958though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4959@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4960the archive search path.
4961
4962@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4963@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4964@cindex input section wildcards
4965@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4966@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4967@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4968In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4969name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4970
4971The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4972pattern for the file name.
4973
4974The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4975
4976@table @samp
4977@item *
4978matches any number of characters
4979@item ?
4980matches any single character
4981@item [@var{chars}]
4982matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4983character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4984@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4985@item \
4986quotes the following character
4987@end table
4988
4989When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4990will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4991Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4992exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4993@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4994a @samp{/} character.
4995
4996File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4997specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4998does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4999
5000If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5001appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5002will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5003sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5004@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5005@smallexample
5006.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5007.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5008@end smallexample
5009
bcaa7b3e 5010@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5011Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5012in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5013this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5014pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5015@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5016into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5017
bcaa7b3e 5018@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5019@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5020@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5021alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5022alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5023needed.
bcaa7b3e 5024
02ecc8e9 5025@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5026@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5027@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5028numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5029section name before placing them in the output file. In
5030@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5031the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5032@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5033
bcaa7b3e
L
5034@cindex SORT
5035@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5036
5037When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5038can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5039
5040@enumerate
5041@item
5042@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5043It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5044sections have the same name.
5045@item
5046@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5047It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5048sections have the same alignment.
5049@item
c0065db7 5050@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5051treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5052@item
5053@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5054is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5055@item
5056All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5057@end enumerate
5058
a05a5b64 5059When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5060section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5061takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5062
5063If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5064command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5065treated as nested sorting command.
5066
5067@enumerate
5068@item
5069@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5070@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5071@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5072@item
5073@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5074@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5075@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5076@end enumerate
5077
5078If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5079command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5080
eda680f8 5081@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5082@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5083section sorting option.
5084
252b5132
RH
5085If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5086@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5087precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5088
5089This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5090files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5091sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5092The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5093with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5094linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5095@smallexample
5096@group
5097SECTIONS @{
5098 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5099 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5100 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5101 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5102@}
5103@end group
5104@end smallexample
5105
5106@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5107@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5108@cindex common symbol placement
5109@cindex uninitialized data placement
5110A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5111file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5112linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5113named @samp{COMMON}.
5114
5115You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5116other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5117particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5118input files are placed in another section.
5119
5120In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5121@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5122@smallexample
5123.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5124@end smallexample
5125
5126@cindex scommon section
5127@cindex small common symbols
5128Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5129example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5130symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5131different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5132the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5133symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5134to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5135locations.
5136
5137@cindex [COMMON]
5138You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5139notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5140@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5141
5142@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5143@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5144@cindex KEEP
5145@cindex garbage collection
5146When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5147it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5148This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5149with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5150@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5151
5152@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5153@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5154The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5155to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5156start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5157@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5158follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5159@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5160@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5161All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5162files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5163
5164@smallexample
5165@group
5166SECTIONS @{
5167 outputa 0x10000 :
5168 @{
5169 all.o
5170 foo.o (.input1)
5171 @}
36f63dca
NC
5172@end group
5173@group
252b5132
RH
5174 outputb :
5175 @{
5176 foo.o (.input2)
5177 foo1.o (.input1)
5178 @}
36f63dca
NC
5179@end group
5180@group
252b5132
RH
5181 outputc :
5182 @{
5183 *(.input1)
5184 *(.input2)
5185 @}
5186@}
5187@end group
a1ab1d2a 5188@end smallexample
252b5132 5189
cbd0eecf
L
5190If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5191and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5192automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5193__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5194indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5195respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5196C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5197
252b5132 5198@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5199@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5200@cindex data
5201@cindex section data
5202@cindex output section data
5203@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5204@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5205@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5206@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5207@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5208You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5209@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5210an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5211parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5212value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5213counter.
5214
5215The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5216store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5217bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5218stored.
5219
5220For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5221of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5222@smallexample
5223BYTE(1)
5224LONG(addr)
5225@end smallexample
5226
5227When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5228same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5229target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5230@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5231@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5232
5233If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5234which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5235When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5236true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5237endianness of the first input object file.
5238
36f63dca 5239Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5240between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5241@smallexample
5242SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5243@end smallexample
5244whereas this will work:
5245@smallexample
5246SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5247@end smallexample
5248
252b5132
RH
5249@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5250@cindex holes, filling
5251@cindex unspecified memory
5252You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5253current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5254otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5255gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5256with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5257necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5258point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5259than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5260different parts of an output section.
5261
5262This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5263value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5264@smallexample
563e308f 5265FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5266@end smallexample
5267
5268The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5269section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5270part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5271entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5272precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5273expression.
252b5132
RH
5274
5275@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5276@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5277There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5278commands.
5279
5280@table @code
5281@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5282@cindex input filename symbols
5283@cindex filename symbols
5284@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5285The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5286The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5287file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5288the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5289
5290This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5291normally used for any other object file format.
5292
5293@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5294@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5295@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5296@item CONSTRUCTORS
5297When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5298unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5299destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5300arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5301automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5302For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5303linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5304@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5305ignored for other object file formats.
5306
5307The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5308constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5309Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5310the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5311first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5312of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5313compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5314formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5315@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5316the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5317destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5318@code{exit}.
5319
5320For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5321arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5322addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5323and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5324linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5325runtime code expects to see.
5326
5327@smallexample
5328 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5329 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5330 *(.ctors)
5331 LONG(0)
5332 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5333 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5334 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5335 *(.dtors)
5336 LONG(0)
5337 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5338@end smallexample
5339
5340If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5341which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5342are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5343are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5344command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5345@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5346@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5347@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5348
5349Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5350and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5351need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5352scripts.
5353
5354@end table
5355
5356@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5357@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5358@cindex discarding sections
5359@cindex sections, discarding
5360@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5361The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5362This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5363may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5364@smallexample
49c13adb 5365.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5366@end smallexample
5367@noindent
5368will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5369@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5370sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5371space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5372too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5373space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5374@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5375@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5376This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5377
a0976ea4 5378The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5379on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5380symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5381the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5382section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5383
5384@cindex /DISCARD/
5385The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5386input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5387section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5388
99fabbc9
JL
5389This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5390@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5391garbage collection.
5392
a2e098c3
NC
5393Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5394discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5395members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5396Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5397
252b5132 5398@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5399@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5400@cindex output section attributes
5401We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5402like this:
0c71d759 5403
252b5132 5404@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5405@group
7e7d5768 5406@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5407 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5408 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5409 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5410 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5411 @{
5412 @var{output-section-command}
5413 @var{output-section-command}
5414 @dots{}
562d3460 5415 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5416@end group
5417@end smallexample
0c71d759 5418
252b5132
RH
5419We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5420@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5421remaining section attributes.
5422
a1ab1d2a 5423@menu
252b5132
RH
5424* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5425* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5426* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5427* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5428* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5429* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5430* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5431* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5432@end menu
5433
5434@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5435@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5436Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5437parentheses. The following types are defined:
5438
5439@table @code
5440@item NOLOAD
5441The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5442loaded into memory when the program is run.
5443@item DSECT
5444@itemx COPY
5445@itemx INFO
5446@itemx OVERLAY
5447These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5448rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5449marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5450section when the program is run.
5451@end table
5452
5453@kindex NOLOAD
5454@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5455@cindex loading, preventing
5456The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5457the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5458the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5459@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5460need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5461@smallexample
5462@group
5463SECTIONS @{
5464 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5465 @dots{}
5466@}
5467@end group
5468@end smallexample
5469
5470@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5471@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5472@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5473@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5474@cindex load address
5475@cindex section load address
5476Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5477@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5478@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5479specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5480address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5481
ea5cae92
NC
5482The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5483specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5484takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5485load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5486region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5487
5488If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5489section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5490load address:
5491
5492@itemize @bullet
5493@item
5494If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5495the LMA address as well.
5496
5497@item
5498If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5499
5500@item
5501Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5502with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5503section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5504VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5505the last section in the located region.
5506
5507@item
5508If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5509that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5510
5511@item
5512If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5513section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5514@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5515
5516@cindex ROM initialized data
5517@cindex initialized data in ROM
5518This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5519example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5520called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5521@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5522even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5523uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5524defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5525counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5526
5527@smallexample
5528@group
5529SECTIONS
5530 @{
5531 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5532 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5533 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5534 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5535 .bss 0x3000 :
5536 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5537@}
5538@end group
5539@end smallexample
5540
5541The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5542this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5543the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5544how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5545script.
5546
5547@smallexample
5548@group
5549extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5550char *src = &_etext;
5551char *dst = &_data;
5552
ea5cae92
NC
5553/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5554while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5555 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5556
ea5cae92 5557/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5558for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5559 *dst = 0;
5560@end group
5561@end smallexample
5562
bbf115d3
L
5563@node Forced Output Alignment
5564@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5565@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5566@cindex forcing output section alignment
5567@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5568You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5569alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5570intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5571
7e7d5768
AM
5572@node Forced Input Alignment
5573@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5574@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5575@cindex forcing input section alignment
5576@cindex input section alignment
5577You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5578SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5579sections, whether larger or smaller.
5580
0c71d759
NC
5581@node Output Section Constraint
5582@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5583@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5584@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5585@cindex constraints on output sections
5586You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5587of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5588read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5589@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5590
252b5132 5591@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5592@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5593@kindex >@var{region}
5594@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5595@cindex memory regions and sections
5596You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5597using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5598
5599Here is a simple example:
5600@smallexample
5601@group
5602MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5603SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5604@end group
5605@end smallexample
5606
5607@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5608@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5609@kindex :@var{phdr}
5610@cindex section, assigning to program header
5611@cindex program headers and sections
5612You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5613using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5614one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5615assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5616@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5617linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5618
5619Here is a simple example:
5620@smallexample
5621@group
5622PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5623SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5624@end group
5625@end smallexample
5626
5627@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5628@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5629@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5630@cindex section fill pattern
5631@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5632You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5633@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5634(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5635within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5636alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5637necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5638of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5639an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5640fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5641other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5642pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5643expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5644
5645You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5646output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5647
5648Here is a simple example:
5649@smallexample
5650@group
563e308f 5651SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5652@end group
5653@end smallexample
5654
5655@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5656@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5657@kindex OVERLAY
5658@cindex overlays
5659An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5660are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5661the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5662copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5663required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5664can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5665than another.
5666
5667Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5668@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5669output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5670command is as follows:
5671@smallexample
5672@group
5673OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5674 @{
5675 @var{secname1}
5676 @{
5677 @var{output-section-command}
5678 @var{output-section-command}
5679 @dots{}
5680 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5681 @var{secname2}
5682 @{
5683 @var{output-section-command}
5684 @var{output-section-command}
5685 @dots{}
5686 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5687 @dots{}
abc9061b 5688 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5689@end group
5690@end smallexample
5691
5692Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5693section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5694section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5695those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5696except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5697sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5698
abc9061b
CC
5699The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5700the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5701
252b5132
RH
5702The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5703addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5704memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5705whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5706and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5707and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5708
56dd11f0
NC
5709If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5710references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5711the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5712sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5713@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5714
5715For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5716provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5717defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5718@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5719the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5720within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5721symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5722
5723At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5724the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5725
5726Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5727@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5728@smallexample
5729@group
5730 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5731 @{
5732 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5733 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5734 @}
5735@end group
5736@end smallexample
5737@noindent
5738This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5739address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5740@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5741following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5742@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5743@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5744
5745C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5746like the following.
5747
5748@smallexample
5749@group
5750 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5751 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5752 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5753@end group
5754@end smallexample
5755
5756Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5757everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5758example could have been written identically as follows.
5759
5760@smallexample
5761@group
5762 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5763 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5764 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5765 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5766 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5767 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5768 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5769@end group
5770@end smallexample
5771
5772@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5773@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5774@kindex MEMORY
5775@cindex memory regions
5776@cindex regions of memory
5777@cindex allocating memory
5778@cindex discontinuous memory
5779The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5780memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5781
5782The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5783memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5784may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5785can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5786set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5787regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5788around to fit into the available regions.
5789
127fcdff
AB
5790A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5791however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5792specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5793@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5794@smallexample
5795@group
a1ab1d2a 5796MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5797 @{
5798 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5799 @dots{}
5800 @}
5801@end group
5802@end smallexample
5803
5804The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5805region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5806Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5807with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5808must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5809add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5810command.
252b5132
RH
5811
5812@cindex memory region attributes
5813The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5814whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5815not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5816@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5817section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5818the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5819them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5820
5821The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5822@table @samp
5823@item R
5824Read-only section
5825@item W
5826Read/write section
5827@item X
5828Executable section
5829@item A
5830Allocatable section
5831@item I
5832Initialized section
5833@item L
5834Same as @samp{I}
5835@item !
c09e9a8c 5836Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5837@end table
5838
81c688d5 5839If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5840@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5841attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5842unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5843not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5844string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5845or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5846the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5847
5848@kindex ORIGIN =
5849@kindex o =
5850@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5851The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5852the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5853cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5854abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5855@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5856
5857@kindex LENGTH =
5858@kindex len =
5859@kindex l =
5860The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5861region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5862be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5863@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5864
5865In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5866available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5867and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5868linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5869is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5870or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5871explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5872region.
5873
5874@smallexample
5875@group
a1ab1d2a 5876MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5877 @{
5878 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5879 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5880 @}
5881@end group
5882@end smallexample
5883
5884Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5885specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5886@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5887a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5888output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5889was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5890the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5891output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5892region, the linker will issue an error message.
5893
3ec57632 5894It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5895expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5896@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5897
5898@smallexample
5899@group
c0065db7 5900 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5901@end group
5902@end smallexample
5903
252b5132
RH
5904@node PHDRS
5905@section PHDRS Command
5906@kindex PHDRS
5907@cindex program headers
5908@cindex ELF program headers
5909@cindex program segments
5910@cindex segments, ELF
5911The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5912@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5913loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5914program with the @samp{-p} option.
5915
5916When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5917reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5918program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5919This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5920interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5921
5922The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5923in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5924precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5925the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5926not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5927
5928The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5929generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5930ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5931
5932This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5933@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5934
5935@smallexample
5936@group
5937PHDRS
5938@{
5939 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5940 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5941@}
5942@end group
5943@end smallexample
5944
5945The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5946of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5947header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5948with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5949must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5950is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5951
5952Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5953system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5954specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5955sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5956attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5957Section Phdr}.
5958
5959It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5960merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5961repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5962contain the section.
5963
5964If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5965then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5966not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5967convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5968placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5969default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5970segment at all.
5971
5972@kindex FILEHDR
5973@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5974You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5975the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5976The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5977file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5978include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5979segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5980these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5981
5982The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5983value of the keyword.
5984
5985@table @asis
5986@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5987Indicates an unused program header.
5988
5989@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5990Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5991the file.
5992
5993@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5994Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5995
5996@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5997Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5998found.
5999
6000@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6001Indicates a segment holding note information.
6002
6003@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6004A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6005ABI.
6006
6007@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6008Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6009
1a9ccd70
NC
6010@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6011Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6012
252b5132
RH
6013@item @var{expression}
6014An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6015be used for types not defined above.
6016@end table
6017
6018You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6019in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6020@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6021Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6022output section attribute.
6023
6024The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6025which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6026explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6027an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6028header.
6029
6030Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6031headers used on a native ELF system.
6032
6033@example
6034@group
6035PHDRS
6036@{
6037 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6038 interp PT_INTERP ;
6039 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6040 data PT_LOAD ;
6041 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6042@}
6043
6044SECTIONS
6045@{
6046 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6047 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6048 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6049 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6050 @dots{}
6051 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6052 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6053 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6054 @dots{}
6055@}
6056@end group
6057@end example
6058
6059@node VERSION
6060@section VERSION Command
6061@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6062@cindex symbol versions
6063@cindex version script
6064@cindex versions of symbols
6065The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6066only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6067symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6068a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6069shared library.
6070
6071You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6072you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6073also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6074
6075The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6076@smallexample
6077VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6078@end smallexample
6079
6080The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6081Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6082version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6083version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6084version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6085scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6086library.
6087
6088The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6089examples.
6090
6091@smallexample
6092VERS_1.1 @{
6093 global:
6094 foo1;
6095 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6096 old*;
6097 original*;
6098 new*;
252b5132
RH
6099@};
6100
6101VERS_1.2 @{
6102 foo2;
6103@} VERS_1.1;
6104
6105VERS_2.0 @{
6106 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6107 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6108 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6109 "f(int, double)";
6110 @};
252b5132
RH
6111@} VERS_1.2;
6112@end smallexample
6113
6114This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6115version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6116The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6117a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6118of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6119symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6120is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6121in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6122However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6123name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6124
6125Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6126depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6127to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6128
6129Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6130depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6131and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6132
6133When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6134specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6135unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6136unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6137somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6138wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6139wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6140set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6141ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6142
6143The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6144they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6145could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6146However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6147
0f6bf451 6148Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6149in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6150symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6151won't.
6152
6153@smallexample
7c9c73be 6154@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6155@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6156
252b5132
RH
6157When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6158symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6159requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6160shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6161loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6162linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6163application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6164way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6165all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6166search for each symbol reference.
6167
6168The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6169doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6170that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6171functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6172the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6173required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6174that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6175versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6176the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6177
6178There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6179first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6180source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6181script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6182maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6183@smallexample
6184__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6185@end smallexample
6186@noindent
6187in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6188be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6189The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6190@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6191takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6192
6193The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6194function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6195an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6196version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6197linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6198
6199To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6200source file. Here is an example:
6201
6202@smallexample
6203__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6204__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6205__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6206__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6207@end smallexample
6208
6209In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6210unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6211example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6212@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6213
6214When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6215some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6216this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6217@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6218declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6219you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6220
6221If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6222within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6223(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6224specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6225
cb840a31
L
6226You can also specify the language in the version script:
6227
6228@smallexample
6229VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6230@end smallexample
6231
c0065db7 6232The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6233The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6234demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6235patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6236@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6237
86043bbb
MM
6238Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6239described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6240or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6241the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6242whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6243cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6244might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6245should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6246expect when you upgrade.
6247
252b5132
RH
6248@node Expressions
6249@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6250@cindex expressions
6251@cindex arithmetic
6252The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6253that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6254expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6255host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6256
6257You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6258
6259The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6260expressions.
6261
6262@menu
6263* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6264* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6265* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6266* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6267* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6268* Operators:: Operators
6269* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6270* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6271* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6272@end menu
6273
6274@node Constants
6275@subsection Constants
6276@cindex integer notation
6277@cindex constants in linker scripts
6278All constants are integers.
6279
6280As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6281octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6282hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6283@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6284@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6285value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6286
6287@cindex scaled integers
6288@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6289@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6290@cindex suffixes for integers
6291@cindex integer suffixes
6292In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6293constant by
6294@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6295@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6296@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6297@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6298@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6299@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6300@tex
6301${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6302@end tex
6303@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6304respectively. For example, the following
6305all refer to the same quantity:
6306
252b5132 6307@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6308_fourk_1 = 4K;
6309_fourk_2 = 4096;
6310_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6311_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6312@end smallexample
6313
8a308ae8
NC
6314Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6315conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6316
0c71d759
NC
6317@node Symbolic Constants
6318@subsection Symbolic Constants
6319@cindex symbolic constants
6320@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6321It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6322the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6323
6324@table @code
6325@item MAXPAGESIZE
6326@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6327The target's maximum page size.
6328
6329@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6330@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6331The target's default page size.
6332@end table
6333
6334So for example:
6335
6336@smallexample
9d5777a3 6337 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6338@end smallexample
6339
6340will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6341supported by the target.
6342
252b5132
RH
6343@node Symbols
6344@subsection Symbol Names
6345@cindex symbol names
6346@cindex names
6347@cindex quoted symbol names
6348@kindex "
6349Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6350and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6351Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6352specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6353keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6354@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6355"SECTION" = 9;
6356"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6357@end smallexample
6358
6359Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6360to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6361whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6362
ecca9871
L
6363@node Orphan Sections
6364@subsection Orphan Sections
6365@cindex orphan
6366Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6367are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6368script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6369output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6370in which to place the orphaned input section.
6371
6372If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6373an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6374placed at the end of that output section.
6375
6376If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6377sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6378name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6379orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6380one new output section.
6381
6382If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6383then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6384in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6385linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6386attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6387sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6388support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6389
a05a5b64
TP
6390The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6391(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6392output sections an orphan is placed in.
6393
252b5132
RH
6394@node Location Counter
6395@subsection The Location Counter
6396@kindex .
6397@cindex dot
6398@cindex location counter
6399@cindex current output location
6400The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6401current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6402location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6403within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6404anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6405
6406@cindex holes
6407Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6408moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6409location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6410and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6411doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6412
6413@smallexample
6414SECTIONS
6415@{
6416 output :
6417 @{
6418 file1(.text)
6419 . = . + 1000;
6420 file2(.text)
6421 . += 1000;
6422 file3(.text)
563e308f 6423 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6424@}
6425@end smallexample
6426@noindent
6427In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6428located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6429followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6430@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6431@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6432specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6433
5c6bbab8
NC
6434@cindex dot inside sections
6435Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6436current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6437statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6438absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6439however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6440not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6441
6442@smallexample
6443SECTIONS
6444@{
6445 . = 0x100
6446 .text: @{
6447 *(.text)
6448 . = 0x200
6449 @}
6450 . = 0x500
6451 .data: @{
6452 *(.data)
6453 . += 0x600
6454 @}
6455@}
6456@end smallexample
6457
6458The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6459and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6460the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6461much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6462move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6463and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6464the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6465the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6466
b5666f2f
AM
6467@cindex dot outside sections
6468Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6469output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6470needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6471
6472@smallexample
6473SECTIONS
6474@{
6475 start_of_text = . ;
6476 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6477 end_of_text = . ;
6478
6479 start_of_data = . ;
6480 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6481 end_of_data = . ;
6482@}
6483@end smallexample
6484
6485If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6486not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6487between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6488should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6489blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6490the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6491sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6492statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6493special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6494place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6495as follows:
6496
6497@smallexample
6498SECTIONS
6499@{
6500 start_of_text = . ;
6501 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6502 end_of_text = . ;
6503
6504 start_of_data = . ;
6505 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6506 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6507 end_of_data = . ;
6508@}
6509@end smallexample
6510
6511This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6512@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6513placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6514assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6515a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6516section. So you could write:
6517
6518@smallexample
6519SECTIONS
6520@{
6521 start_of_text = . ;
6522 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6523 end_of_text = . ;
6524
6525 . = . ;
6526 start_of_data = . ;
6527 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6528 end_of_data = . ;
6529@}
6530@end smallexample
6531
6532Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6533@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6534
252b5132
RH
6535@need 2000
6536@node Operators
6537@subsection Operators
6538@cindex operators for arithmetic
6539@cindex arithmetic operators
6540@cindex precedence in expressions
6541The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6542the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6543@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6544@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6545@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6546@smallexample
6547precedence associativity Operators Notes
6548(highest)
65491 left ! - ~ (1)
65502 left * / %
65513 left + -
65524 left >> <<
65535 left == != > < <= >=
65546 left &
65557 left |
65568 left &&
65579 left ||
655810 right ? :
655911 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6560(lowest)
6561@end smallexample
6562Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6563(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6564(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6565@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6566@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6567@tex
6568\vskip \baselineskip
6569%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6570\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6571\hrule
6572\halign
6573{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6574height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6575&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6576height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6577\noalign{\hrule}
6578height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6579&highest&&&&&\cr
6580% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6581&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6582&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6583&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6584&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6585&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6586&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6587&7&&left&&|&\cr
6588&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6589&9&&left&&||&\cr
6590&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6591&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6592&lowest&&&&&\cr
6593height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6594\hrule}
6595@end tex
6596@iftex
6597{
6598@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6599@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6600@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6601}
6602@end iftex
6603@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6604
6605@node Evaluation
6606@subsection Evaluation
6607@cindex lazy evaluation
6608@cindex expression evaluation order
6609The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6610an expression when absolutely necessary.
6611
6612The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6613address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6614regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6615as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6616
6617However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6618until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6619other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6620for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6621
6622The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6623assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6624allocation.
6625
6626Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6627@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6628
6629If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6630available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6631following
6632@smallexample
6633@group
6634SECTIONS
6635 @{
a1ab1d2a 6636 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6637 @{ *(.text) @}
6638 @}
6639@end group
6640@end smallexample
6641@noindent
6642will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6643address}.
6644
6645@node Expression Section
6646@subsection The Section of an Expression
6647@cindex expression sections
6648@cindex absolute expressions
6649@cindex relative expressions
6650@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6651@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6652@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6653Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6654relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6655using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6656value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6657symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6658operations.
6659
abf4be64
AM
6660Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6661section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6662address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6663@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6664functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6665One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6666(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6667differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6668versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6669section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6670Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6671absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6672given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6673everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6674
6675In the following simple example,
252b5132 6676
7542af2a
AM
6677@smallexample
6678@group
6679SECTIONS
6680 @{
6681 . = 0x100;
6682 __executable_start = 0x100;
6683 .data :
6684 @{
6685 . = 0x10;
6686 __data_start = 0x10;
6687 *(.data)
6688 @}
6689 @dots{}
6690 @}
6691@end group
6692@end smallexample
252b5132 6693
7542af2a
AM
6694both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6695address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6696@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6697section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6698
5c3049d2
AM
6699For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6700addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6701
6702@itemize @bullet
6703@item
c05f749e
AM
6704Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6705operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6706absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6707@item
7542af2a
AM
6708Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6709relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6710and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6711@item
c05f749e
AM
6712Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6713in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6714address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6715before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6716@end itemize
6717
6718The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6719
6720@itemize @bullet
6721@item
6722An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6723@item
6724The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6725@item
9bc8bb33 6726The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6727relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6728(after above conversions) is also a number when
6729@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6730but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6731@item
6732The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6733relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6734section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6735@item
6736The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6737conversions) is an absolute address.
6738@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6739
6740You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6741to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6742create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6743section @samp{.data}:
6744@smallexample
6745SECTIONS
6746 @{
6747 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6748 @}
6749@end smallexample
6750@noindent
6751If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6752@samp{.data} section.
6753
7542af2a
AM
6754Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6755particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6756
252b5132
RH
6757@node Builtin Functions
6758@subsection Builtin Functions
6759@cindex functions in expressions
6760The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6761use in linker script expressions.
6762
6763@table @code
6764@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6765@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6766@cindex expression, absolute
6767Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6768of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6769value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6770normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6771
6772@item ADDR(@var{section})
6773@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6774@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6775Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6776script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6777the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6778@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6779@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6780the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6781@smallexample
6782@group
6783SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6784 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6785 @{
252b5132
RH
6786 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6787 @dots{}
6788 @}
6789 .output :
6790 @{
6791 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6792 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6793 @}
6794@dots{} @}
6795@end group
6796@end smallexample
6797
876f4090
NS
6798@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6799@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6800@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6801@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6802@cindex round up location counter
6803@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6804@cindex round up expression
6805@cindex align expression
6806Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6807to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6808doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6809arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6810expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6811equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6812
6813Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6814next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6815variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6816input sections:
252b5132
RH
6817@smallexample
6818@group
6819SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6820 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6821 *(.data)
6822 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6823 @}
6824@dots{} @}
6825@end group
6826@end smallexample
6827@noindent
6828The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6829a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6830a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6831of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6832
6833The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6834
362c1d1a
NS
6835@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6836@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6837@cindex section alignment
6838Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6839been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6840evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6841the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6842value in that section.
6843@smallexample
6844@group
6845SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6846 .output @{
6847 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6848 @dots{}
6849 @}
6850@dots{} @}
6851@end group
6852@end smallexample
6853
252b5132
RH
6854@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6855@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6856This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6857scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6858section.
6859
2d20f7bf
JJ
6860@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6861@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6862This is equivalent to either
6863@smallexample
6864(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6865@end smallexample
6866or
6867@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6868(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6869 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6870@end smallexample
6871@noindent
6872depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6873for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6874@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6875If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6876memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6877bytes in the on-disk file.
6878
6879This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6880any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6881@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6882be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6883running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6884that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6885page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6886
6887@noindent
6888Example:
6889@smallexample
6890 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6891@end smallexample
6892
6893@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6894@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6895This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6896evaluation purposes.
6897
6898@smallexample
6899 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6900@end smallexample
6901
a4f5ad88
JJ
6902@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6903@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6904This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6905@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6906When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6907does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6908@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6909argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6910script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6911@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6912padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6913section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6914
6915@smallexample
6916 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6917@end smallexample
6918
252b5132
RH
6919@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6920@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6921@cindex symbol defaults
6922Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6923defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6924return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6925default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6926shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6927the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6928existed, its value is preserved:
6929
6930@smallexample
6931@group
6932SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6933 .text : @{
6934 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6935 @dots{}
6936 @}
6937 @dots{}
6938@}
6939@end group
6940@end smallexample
6941
3ec57632
NC
6942@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6943@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6944Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6945
252b5132
RH
6946@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6947@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6948@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6949Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6950Section LMA}).
6951
2e53f7d6
NC
6952@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6953@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6954Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6955@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6956
252b5132
RH
6957@kindex MAX
6958@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6959Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6960
6961@kindex MIN
6962@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6963Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6964
6965@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6966@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6967@cindex unallocated address, next
6968Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6969This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6970use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6971output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6972
3ec57632
NC
6973@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6974@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6975Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6976
ba916c8a
MM
6977@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6978@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6979Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6980value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6981@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6982will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6983can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6984``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6985name.
6986
252b5132
RH
6987@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6988@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6989@cindex section size
6990Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6991been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6992evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6993@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6994@smallexample
6995@group
6996SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6997 .output @{
6998 .start = . ;
6999 @dots{}
7000 .end = . ;
7001 @}
7002 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7003 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7004@dots{} @}
7005@end group
7006@end smallexample
7007
7008@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7009@itemx sizeof_headers
7010@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7011@cindex header size
7012Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7013information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7014this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7015choose, to facilitate paging.
7016
7017@cindex not enough room for program headers
7018@cindex program headers, not enough room
7019When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7020@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7021number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7022addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7023additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7024room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7025the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7026script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7027you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7028command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7029@end table
7030
7031@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7032@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7033@cindex implicit linker scripts
7034If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7035an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7036linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7037linker will report an error.
7038
7039An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7040
7041Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7042assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7043commands.
7044
7045Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7046at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7047read. This can affect archive searching.
7048
bf6d8037
HC
7049@node Plugins
7050@chapter Linker Plugins
7051
7052@cindex plugins
7053@cindex linker plugins
7054The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7055For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7056support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7057
7058Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7059be added here later.
7060
7061@menu
7062* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7063@end menu
7064
7065@node libdep Plugin
7066@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7067@cindex static library dependencies
7068Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7069just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7070optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7071within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7072rose to ascendance.
7073
7074One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7075multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7076dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7077library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7078referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7079link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7080libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7081explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7082
7083The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7084to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7085plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7086dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7087and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7088command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7089utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7090being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7091archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7092
7093For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7094library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7095the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7096
7097@smallexample
7098-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7099@end smallexample
7100
252b5132
RH
7101@ifset GENERIC
7102@node Machine Dependent
7103@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7104
7105@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7106@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7107sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7108functionality are not listed.
7109
7110@menu
36f63dca
NC
7111@ifset H8300
7112* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7113@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7114@ifset M68HC11
7115* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7116@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7117@ifset ARM
7118* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7119@end ifset
7120@ifset HPPA
7121* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7122@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7123@ifset M68K
7124* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7125@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7126@ifset MIPS
7127* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7128@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7129@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7130* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7131@end ifset
2469cfa2 7132@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7133* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7134@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7135@ifset NDS32
7136* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7137@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7138@ifset NIOSII
7139* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7140@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7141@ifset POWERPC
7142* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7143@end ifset
7144@ifset POWERPC64
7145* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7146@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7147@ifset S/390
7148* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7149@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7150@ifset SPU
7151* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7152@end ifset
74459f0e 7153@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7154* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7155@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7156@ifset WIN32
7157* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7158@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7159@ifset XTENSA
7160* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7161@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7162@end menu
7163@end ifset
7164
252b5132
RH
7165@ifset H8300
7166@ifclear GENERIC
7167@raisesections
7168@end ifclear
7169
7170@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7171@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7172
7173@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7174For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7175you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7176
7177@table @emph
7178@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7179@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7180@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7181targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7182program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7183respectively.
7184
7185@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7186@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7187@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7188@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7189sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7190page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7191(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7192@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7193top page of memory).
1502569c 7194
81f5558e
NC
7195@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7196indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7197displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7198the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7199@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7200whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7201range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7202
1502569c 7203@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7204@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7205biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7206which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7207page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7208(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7209@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7210the top page of memory).
7211
7212@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7213@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
721432 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7215changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7216(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7217@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7218the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7219@end table
7220
7221@ifclear GENERIC
7222@lowersections
7223@end ifclear
7224@end ifset
7225
36f63dca 7226@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7227@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7228@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7229@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7230@node Renesas
7231@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7232
c2dcd04e
NC
7233@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7234H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7235options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7236@end ifset
7237@end ifclear
7238
36f63dca
NC
7239@ifset ARM
7240@ifclear GENERIC
7241@raisesections
7242@end ifclear
7243
93fd0973
SC
7244@ifset M68HC11
7245@ifclear GENERIC
7246@raisesections
7247@end ifclear
7248
7249@node M68HC11/68HC12
7250@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7251
7252@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7253
7254@subsection Linker Relaxation
7255
7256For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7257optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7258
7259@table @emph
7260@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7261@item relaxing address modes
7262@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7263targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7264program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7265respectively.
7266
7267@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7268transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7269page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7270
7271@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7272When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7273of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7274addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7275@code{bset} instructions.
7276
7277@end table
7278
7279@subsection Trampoline Generation
7280
7281@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7282@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7283For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7284call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7285will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7286trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7287case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7288point to the function trampoline.
7289
7290@ifclear GENERIC
7291@lowersections
7292@end ifclear
7293@end ifset
7294
36f63dca 7295@node ARM
3674e28a 7296@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7297
7298@cindex ARM interworking support
7299@kindex --support-old-code
7300For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7301between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7302been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7303line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7304libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7305option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7306given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7307which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7308the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7309non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7310
7311@cindex thumb entry point
7312@cindex entry point, thumb
7313@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7314The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7315@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7316But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7317branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7318executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7319
ce11ba6c
KT
7320@cindex PE import table prefixing
7321@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7322The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7323the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7324element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7325import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7326
e489d0ae
PB
7327@cindex BE8
7328@kindex --be8
7329The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7330executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7331objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7332option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7333little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7334
3674e28a
PB
7335@cindex TARGET1
7336@kindex --target1-rel
7337@kindex --target1-abs
7338The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7339@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7340or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7341and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7342
7343@cindex TARGET2
7344@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7345The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7346@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7347meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7348@table @samp
7349@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7350@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7351@item abs
a57d1773 7352@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7353@item got-rel
7354@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7355@end table
7356
319850b4
JB
7357@cindex FIX_V4BX
7358@kindex --fix-v4bx
7359The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7360specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7361interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7362also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7363
7364In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7365linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7366@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7367
7368In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7369relocations are ignored.
7370
845b51d6
PB
7371@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7372@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7373Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7374relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7375
7376@smallexample
7377TST rM, #1
7378MOVEQ PC, rM
7379BX Rn
7380@end smallexample
7381
7382This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7383and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7384condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7385
33bfe774
JB
7386@cindex USE_BLX
7387@kindex --use-blx
7388The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7389BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7390situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7391code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7392each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7393
c6dd86c6
JB
7394@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7395@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7396The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7397bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7398instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7399to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7400the support code can read the intended values.
7401
7402The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7403intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7404and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7405intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7406full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7407you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7408
7409If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7410enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7411@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7412mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7413vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7414@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7415
7416If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7417potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7418such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7419first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7420instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7421the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7422are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7423
2de70689
MGD
7424@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7425@kindex --fix-arm1176
7426@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7427The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7428in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7429are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7430unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7431
9d5777a3 7432Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7433Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7434http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7435
a504d23a
LA
7436@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7437@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7438
7439The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7440workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7441the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7442off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7443the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7444core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7445integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7446VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7447
7448The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7449necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7450
7451The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7452@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7453STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7454linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7455@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7456
7457If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7458potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7459such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7460replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7461branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7462then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7463
7464The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7465the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7466
7467The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7468they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7469there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7470occurs.
7471
7472The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7473PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7474large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7475cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7476occurs.
7477
bf21ed78
MS
7478@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7479@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7480The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7481warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7482enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7483linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7484using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7485not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7486
7487@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7488@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7489The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7490warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7491@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7492linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7493using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7494
726150b7
NC
7495@cindex PIC_VENEER
7496@kindex --pic-veneer
7497The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7498ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7499is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7500@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7501
7502@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7503@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7504The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7505code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7506perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7507placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7508controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7509The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7510duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7511group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7512code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7513where they should be placed.
7514
7515The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7516@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7517placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7518branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7519placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7520value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7521exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7522A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7523linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7524from the input sections.
7525
7526The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7527@samp{N = +1}.
7528
1a51c1a4
NC
7529Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7530only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7531otherwise.
7532
1db37fe6
YG
7533@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7534@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7535@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7536The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7537
7538The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7539
68fcca92
JW
7540@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7541@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7542@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7543The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7544
7545Please contact ARM for further details.
7546
1db37fe6
YG
7547@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7548@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7549@cindex Merging exidx entries
7550The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7551
7552@kindex --long-plt
7553@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7554The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7555which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7556entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7557
1f56df9d
JW
7558@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7559@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7560The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7561link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7562
4ba2ef8f
TP
7563@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7564All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7565Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7566@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7567veneers in memory.
7568
54ddd295
TP
7569@kindex --cmse-implib
7570@cindex Secure gateway import library
7571The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7572specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7573secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7574executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7575
0955507f
TP
7576@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7577@cindex Input import library
7578The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7579must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7580given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7581in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7582@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7583library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7584library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7585for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7586specified.
7587
36f63dca
NC
7588@ifclear GENERIC
7589@lowersections
7590@end ifclear
7591@end ifset
7592
7593@ifset HPPA
7594@ifclear GENERIC
7595@raisesections
7596@end ifclear
7597
7598@node HPPA ELF32
7599@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7600@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7601@kindex --multi-subspace
7602When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7603import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7604The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7605stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7606multiple sub-spaces.
7607
7608@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7609@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7610Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7611stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7612@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7613sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7614a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7615the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7616conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7617prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7618A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7619branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7620@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7621@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7622detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7623positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7624
7625Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7626single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7627create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7628large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7629
7630@ifclear GENERIC
7631@lowersections
7632@end ifclear
7633@end ifset
7634
7fb9f789
NC
7635@ifset M68K
7636@ifclear GENERIC
7637@raisesections
7638@end ifclear
7639
7640@node M68K
7641@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7642
7643@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7644@kindex --got=@var{type}
7645The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7646The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7647@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7648the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7649@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7650entries only at non-negative offsets.
7651@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7652entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7653support such GOTs.
7654@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7655output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7656file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7657files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7658
7659@ifclear GENERIC
7660@lowersections
7661@end ifclear
7662@end ifset
7663
833794fc
MR
7664@ifset MIPS
7665@ifclear GENERIC
7666@raisesections
7667@end ifclear
7668
7669@node MIPS
7670@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7671
7672@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7673@kindex --insn32
7674@kindex --no-insn32
7675The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7676microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7677in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7678used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7679or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7680including 16-bit ones where possible.
7681
8b10b0b3
MR
7682@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7683@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7684@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7685The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7686control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7687@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7688relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7689calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7690relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7691instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7692or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7693the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7694
833794fc
MR
7695@ifclear GENERIC
7696@lowersections
7697@end ifclear
7698@end ifset
7699
36f63dca
NC
7700@ifset MMIX
7701@ifclear GENERIC
7702@raisesections
7703@end ifclear
7704
7705@node MMIX
7706@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7707For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7708@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7709understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7710can translate between the two formats.
7711
7712There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7713Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7714registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7715equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7716@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7717global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7718this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7719symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7720
7a2de473
HPN
7721Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7722@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7723The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7724of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7725
7726Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7727are left out from an mmo file.
7728
7729@ifclear GENERIC
7730@lowersections
7731@end ifclear
7732@end ifset
7733
7734@ifset MSP430
7735@ifclear GENERIC
7736@raisesections
7737@end ifclear
7738
7739@node MSP430
7740@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7741For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7742will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7743just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7744
7745@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7746The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7747
7748@table @code
7749@item @samp{.vectors}
7750Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7751
7752@item @samp{.bootloader}
7753Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7754in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7755
7756@item @samp{.infomem}
7757Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7758this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7759
c0065db7 7760@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7761This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7762in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7763
7764@item @samp{.noinit}
7765Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7766
c0065db7 7767The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7768@end table
7769
7ef3addb
JL
7770@table @option
7771@cindex MSP430 Options
7772@kindex --code-region
7773@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7774This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7775argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7776using this option.
7777
7778@kindex --data-region
7779@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7780This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7781[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7782for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7783
7784@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7785@item --disable-sec-transformation
7786Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7787and @code{--data-region} options.
7788This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7789wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7790not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7791@end table
7792
36f63dca
NC
7793@ifclear GENERIC
7794@lowersections
7795@end ifclear
7796@end ifset
7797
35c08157
KLC
7798@ifset NDS32
7799@ifclear GENERIC
7800@raisesections
7801@end ifclear
7802
7803@node NDS32
7804@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7805@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7806For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7807relaxes objects according to these options.
7808
7809@table @code
7810@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7811Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7812
7813@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7814Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7815
7816@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7817Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7818
7819@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7820Export the EX9 table after linking.
7821
7822@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7823Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7824
7825@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7826Update the existing EX9 table.
7827
7828@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7829Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7830
7831@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7832Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7833
7834@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7835Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7836
7837@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7838Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7839@end table
7840
7841@ifclear GENERIC
7842@lowersections
7843@end ifclear
7844@end ifset
7845
78058a5e
SL
7846@ifset NIOSII
7847@ifclear GENERIC
7848@raisesections
7849@end ifclear
7850
7851@node Nios II
7852@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7853@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7854@kindex --relax on Nios II
7855
7856Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7857transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7858which may result in @command{ld} giving
7859@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7860The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7861trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7862outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7863trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7864be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7865larger than 256MB.
7866
7867The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7868is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7869@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7870locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7871source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7872register as a temporary.
7873
7874Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7875relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7876option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7877
7878@ifclear GENERIC
7879@lowersections
7880@end ifclear
7881@end ifset
7882
2a60a7a8
AM
7883@ifset POWERPC
7884@ifclear GENERIC
7885@raisesections
7886@end ifclear
7887
7888@node PowerPC ELF32
7889@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7890@cindex PowerPC long branches
7891@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7892Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7893displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7894@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7895@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7896the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7897section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7898section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7899@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7900both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7901considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7902
7903@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7904@table @option
7905@cindex PowerPC PLT
7906@kindex --bss-plt
7907@item --bss-plt
7908Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7909generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7910the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7911writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7912@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7913PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7914compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7915BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7916
016687f8
AM
7917@kindex --secure-plt
7918@item --secure-plt
7919@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7920@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7921when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7922layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7923style BSS PLT.
7924
2a60a7a8
AM
7925@cindex PowerPC GOT
7926@kindex --sdata-got
7927@item --sdata-got
7928The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7929sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7930@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7931section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7932@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7933@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7934@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7935@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7936PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7937pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7938GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7939really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7940
7941@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7942@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7943@item --emit-stub-syms
7944This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7945symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7946
7947@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7948@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7949@item --no-tls-optimize
7950PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7951sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7952disable the optimization.
7953@end table
7954
7955@ifclear GENERIC
7956@lowersections
7957@end ifclear
7958@end ifset
7959
7960@ifset POWERPC64
7961@ifclear GENERIC
7962@raisesections
7963@end ifclear
7964
7965@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7966@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7967
7968@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7969@table @option
7970@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7971@kindex --stub-group-size
7972@item --stub-group-size
7973Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7974by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7975@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7976sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7977a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7978the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7979conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7980prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7981A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7982branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7983@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7984@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7985detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7986positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7987
7988Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7989single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7990create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7991large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7992
7993@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7994@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7995@item --emit-stub-syms
7996This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7997symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7998
7999@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8000@kindex --dotsyms
8001@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8002@item --dotsyms
8003@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8004These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8005in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8006function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8007code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8008properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8009to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8010@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8011dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8012feature.
8013
7ae4ea7d
AM
8014@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8015@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8016@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8017@item --save-restore-funcs
8018@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8019These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8020provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8021@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8022function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8023link.
8024
2a60a7a8
AM
8025@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8026@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8027@item --no-tls-optimize
8028PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8029sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8030disable the optimization.
8031
7c9cf415
AM
8032@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8033@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8034@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8035@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8036@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8037@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8038@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8039These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8040stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8041an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8042@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8043stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8044generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8045__tls_get_addr_opt.
8046Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8047much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8048an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8049will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8050@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8051and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8052this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8053Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8054@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8055register saves.
7c9cf415 8056
2a60a7a8
AM
8057@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8058@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8059@item --no-opd-optimize
8060PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8061corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8062the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8063Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8064
8065@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8066@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8067@item --non-overlapping-opd
8068Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8069@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8070the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8071entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8072
8073@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8074@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8075@item --no-toc-optimize
8076PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8077entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8078reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8079marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8080marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8081relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8082unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8083reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8084discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8085reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8086code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8087optimization.
8088
d882c988
AM
8089@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8090@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8091@item --no-inline-optimize
8092PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8093marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8094@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8095a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8096locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8097disables that optimization.
8098
2a60a7a8
AM
8099@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8100@kindex --no-multi-toc
8101@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8102If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8103@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8104where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8105entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8106total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8107grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8108TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8109calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8110help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
811164K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8112Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8113
8114@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8115@kindex --no-toc-sort
8116@item --no-toc-sort
8117By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8118happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8119placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8120with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8121referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8122@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8123results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8124off this feature.
8125
8126@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8127@kindex --plt-align
8128@kindex --no-plt-align
8129@item --plt-align
8130@itemx --no-plt-align
8131Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8132aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8133boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8134specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8135specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8136if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8137PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8138
8139@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8140@kindex --plt-static-chain
8141@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8142@item --plt-static-chain
8143@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8144Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8145chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8146chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8147
8148@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8149@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8150@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8151@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8152@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8153With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8154lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8155another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8156order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8157memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8158barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8159looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8160seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8161default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8162
8163@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8164@kindex --plt-localentry
8165@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8166@item --plt-localentry
8167@itemx --no-localentry
8168ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8169ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8170(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8171Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8172or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8173functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8174in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8175interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8176including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8177to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8178complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8179care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8180
8181@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8182@kindex --power10-stubs
8183@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8184@item --power10-stubs
8185@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8186When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8187relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8188linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8189for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8190power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8191power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8192allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8193@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8194auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8195@end table
8196
8197@ifclear GENERIC
8198@lowersections
8199@end ifclear
8200@end ifset
8201
b4cbbe8f
AK
8202@ifset S/390
8203@ifclear GENERIC
8204@raisesections
8205@end ifclear
8206
8207@node S/390 ELF
8208@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8209
8210@cindex S/390 ELF options
8211@table @option
8212
8213@cindex S/390
8214@kindex --s390-pgste
8215@item --s390-pgste
8216This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8217segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8218binaries marked that way.
8219@end table
8220
8221@ifclear GENERIC
8222@lowersections
8223@end ifclear
8224@end ifset
8225
49fa1e15
AM
8226@ifset SPU
8227@ifclear GENERIC
8228@raisesections
8229@end ifclear
8230
8231@node SPU ELF
8232@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8233
8234@cindex SPU ELF options
8235@table @option
8236
8237@cindex SPU plugins
8238@kindex --plugin
8239@item --plugin
8240This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8241
8242@cindex SPU overlays
8243@kindex --no-overlays
8244@item --no-overlays
8245Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8246regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8247@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8248turns off all this special overlay handling.
8249
8250@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8251@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8252@item --emit-stub-syms
8253This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8254symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8255
8256@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8257@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8258@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8259This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8260function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8261on calls to non-overlay regions.
8262
8263@cindex SPU local store size
8264@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8265@item --local-store=lo:hi
8266@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8267the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8268range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8269
c0065db7 8270@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8271@kindex --stack-analysis
8272@item --stack-analysis
8273SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8274unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8275under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8276@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8277@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8278determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8279for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8280for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8281for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8282find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8283and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8284under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8285dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8286is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8287and calls will be given.
8288
c0065db7 8289@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8290@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8291@item --emit-stack-syms
8292This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8293in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8294These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8295functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8296functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8297such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8298The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8299@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8300@end table
8301
8302@ifclear GENERIC
8303@lowersections
8304@end ifclear
8305@end ifset
8306
36f63dca
NC
8307@ifset TICOFF
8308@ifclear GENERIC
8309@raisesections
8310@end ifclear
8311
8312@node TI COFF
8313@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8314@cindex TI COFF versions
8315@kindex --format=@var{version}
8316The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8317TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8318also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8319format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8320header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8321
8322@ifclear GENERIC
8323@lowersections
8324@end ifclear
8325@end ifset
8326
2ca22b03
NC
8327@ifset WIN32
8328@ifclear GENERIC
8329@raisesections
8330@end ifclear
8331
8332@node WIN32
8333@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8334
c0065db7 8335This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8336See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8337command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8338
8339@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8340@cindex import libraries
8341@item import libraries
69da35b5 8342The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8343libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8344regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8345archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8346support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8347@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8348
c0065db7
RM
8349@item exporting DLL symbols
8350@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8351The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8352
8353@table @emph
8354@item using auto-export functionality
8355@cindex using auto-export functionality
8356By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8357which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8358
0a5d968e
NC
8359@itemize
8360@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8361@item --exclude-symbols
8362@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8363@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8364@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8365@end itemize
8366
09e2aba4
DK
8367When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8368(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8369symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8370often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8371private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8372options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8373exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8374final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8375
8376If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8377command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8378if either of the following are true:
8379
8380@itemize
8381@item A DEF file is used.
8382@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8383@end itemize
dc8465bf 8384
c0065db7
RM
8385@item using a DEF file
8386@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8387Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8388an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8389exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8390name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8391command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8392
8393@example
8394gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8395@end example
8396
0a5d968e
NC
8397Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8398@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8399
dc8465bf
NC
8400Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8401
8402@example
4b5bd4e7 8403LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8404
8405EXPORTS
8406foo
8407bar
8408_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8409another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8410var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8411doo = foo == foo2
8412eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8413@end example
dc8465bf 8414
7fcab871 8415This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8416symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8417alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8418by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8419@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8420@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8421export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8422in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8423symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8424
6b31ad16
DS
8425The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8426name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8427the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8428
b45619c0
NC
8429When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8430library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8431@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8432executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8433
8434With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8435specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8436non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8437
8438If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8439or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8440filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8441
4b5bd4e7
DS
8442The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8443
8444@example
8445EXPORTS
8446 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8447 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8448 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8449@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8450
8451Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8452@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8453@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8454@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8455Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8456@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8457string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8458
8459The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8460
8461@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8462will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8463by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8464linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8465library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8466
8467@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8468The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8469the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8470@code{*_imp__foo}).
8471
8472@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8473well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8474read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8475variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8476the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8477extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8478application will behave unexpectedly.
8479
8480@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8481it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8482symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8483API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8484the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8485
4b5bd4e7
DS
8486See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8487other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8488
8489@cindex creating a DEF file
8490While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8491with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8492
8493@item Using decorations
8494@cindex Using decorations
8495Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8496itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8497declared as:
8498
8499@example
8500__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8501__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8502@end example
8503
8504All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8505any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8506this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8507the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8508
8509Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8510decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8511instead:
8512
8513@example
8514__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8515__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8516@end example
8517
c0065db7
RM
8518This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8519when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8520variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8521code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8522of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8523omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8524@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8525information.
c0065db7 8526@end table
dc8465bf 8527
2ca22b03
NC
8528@cindex automatic data imports
8529@item automatic data imports
8530The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8531by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8532compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8533issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8534code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8535c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8536initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8537decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8538platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8539command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8540The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8541suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8542trigger the feature's use.
8543
c0065db7 8544auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8545additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8546
c0065db7 8547"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8548documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8549
c0065db7
RM
8550The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8551occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8552One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8553below.
8554
8555@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8556For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8557object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8558offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8559field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8560in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8561without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8562The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8563references.
8564
c0065db7
RM
8565The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8566be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8567themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8568runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8569compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8570support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8571run without error on an older system.
8572
c0065db7
RM
8573@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8574enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8575
8576@cindex direct linking to a dll
8577@item direct linking to a dll
8578The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8579including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8580libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8581traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8582libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8583function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8584though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8585storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8586tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8587large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8588
c0065db7 8589Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8590@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8591of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8592perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8593select the dll instead of an import library.
8594
2ca22b03 8595
69da35b5
NC
8596For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8597to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8598
8599@example
45e948fe
NC
8600libxxx.dll.a
8601xxx.dll.a
8602libxxx.a
8603xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8604libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8605cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8606libxxx.dll
8607xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8608@end example
8609
69da35b5
NC
8610before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8611
c0065db7
RM
8612(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8613where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8614@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8615file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8616@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8617
c0065db7
RM
8618Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8619@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8620was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8621various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8622could coexist on the same machine.
8623
2ca22b03
NC
8624The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8625applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8626libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8627
8628@example
8629bin/
8630 cygxxx.dll
8631lib/
8632 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8633 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8634@end example
8635
c0065db7
RM
8636Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8637done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8638
86391. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8640@example
8641gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8642@end example
2ca22b03 8643
69da35b5
NC
8644However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8645(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8646@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8647not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8648
2ca22b03
NC
86492. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8650directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8651should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8652making the app/dll.
8653
8654@example
8655ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8656@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8657
8658Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8659
8660@example
8661gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8662@end example
69da35b5
NC
8663
8664This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8665perfectly legal
8666
8667@example
8668bin/
8669 cygxxx-5.dll
8670lib/
c0065db7 8671 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8672@end example
8673
dc8465bf 8674Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8675even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8676@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8677
8678Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8679wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8680
86811. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8682work with auto-imported data.
8683
dc8465bf
NC
86842. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8685import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8686symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8687for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8688possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8689
45e948fe
NC
86903. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8691critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8692in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8693stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8694
69da35b5 8695So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8696true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8697a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8698binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8699massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8700requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8701will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8702
c0065db7 8703@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8704@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8705@item adding additional names
8706Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8707A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8708exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8709when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8710import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8711
c0065db7 8712@example
dc8465bf
NC
8713LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8714
8715EXPORTS
c0065db7 8716foo
dc8465bf 8717_foo = foo
c0065db7 8718@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8719
8720The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8721
8722Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8723source code using the "weak" attribute:
8724
c0065db7
RM
8725@example
8726void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8727void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8728@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8729
8730See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8731symbols.
8732
8733@item renaming symbols
8734Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8735kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8736@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8737DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8738created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8739
c0065db7 8740@example
dc8465bf
NC
8741LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8742
8743EXPORTS
8744_foo = foo
c0065db7 8745@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8746
8747The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8748@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8749@end table
dc8465bf 8750
0a5d968e 8751Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8752unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8753If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8754@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8755that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8756@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8757renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8758to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8759the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8760In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8761which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8762
8763@cindex weak externals
8764@item weak externals
8765The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8766weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8767defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8768are three variants of weak externals:
8769@itemize
8770@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8771called lazy externals.
8772@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8773This form is not presently implemented.
8774@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8775implemented.
8776@end itemize
8777As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8778are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8779uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8780
8781@cindex aligned common symbols
8782@item aligned common symbols
8783As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8784desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8785the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8786carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8787by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8788tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8789but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8790warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8791
2ca22b03
NC
8792@end table
8793
8794@ifclear GENERIC
8795@lowersections
8796@end ifclear
8797@end ifset
8798
e0001a05
NC
8799@ifset XTENSA
8800@ifclear GENERIC
8801@raisesections
8802@end ifclear
8803
8804@node Xtensa
8805@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8806
8807@cindex Xtensa processors
8808The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8809@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8810specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8811keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8812example, with the command:
8813
8814@smallexample
8815SECTIONS
8816@{
8817 .text : @{
8818 *(.literal .text)
8819 @}
8820@}
8821@end smallexample
8822
8823@noindent
8824@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8825and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8826literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8827interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8828group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8829files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8830and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8831
43cd72b9 8832@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8833@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8834Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8835provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8836is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8837literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8838will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8839location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8840the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8841unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8842@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8843range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8844
8845For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8846to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8847instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8848instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8849instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8850@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8851hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8852By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8853switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8854density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8855instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8856performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8857linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8858a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8859
8860The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8861control the linker:
8862
8863@cindex Xtensa options
8864@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8865@item --size-opt
8866When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8867more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8868no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8869alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8870preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8871
8872@item --abi-windowed
8873@itemx --abi-call0
8874Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8875PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8876because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8877conventions.
8878Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8879of the first input object.
8880A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8881or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8882@end table
e0001a05
NC
8883
8884@ifclear GENERIC
8885@lowersections
8886@end ifclear
8887@end ifset
8888
252b5132
RH
8889@ifclear SingleFormat
8890@node BFD
8891@chapter BFD
8892
8893@cindex back end
8894@cindex object file management
8895@cindex object formats available
8896@kindex objdump -i
8897The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8898These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8899object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8900format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8901it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8902associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8903object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8904(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8905list all the formats available for your configuration.
8906
8907@cindex BFD requirements
8908@cindex requirements for BFD
8909As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8910several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8911BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8912formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8913been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8914BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8915may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8916
8917One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8918mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8919useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8920conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8921
8922@menu
8923* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8924@end menu
8925
8926@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8927@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8928@cindex opening object files
8929@include bfdsumm.texi
8930@end ifclear
8931
8932@node Reporting Bugs
8933@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8934@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8935@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8936
ff5dcc92 8937Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8938
8939Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8940it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8941to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8942work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8943@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8944
8945In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8946information that enables us to fix the bug.
8947
8948@menu
8949* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8950* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8951@end menu
8952
8953@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8954@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8955@cindex bug criteria
8956
8957If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8958
8959@itemize @bullet
8960@cindex fatal signal
8961@cindex linker crash
8962@cindex crash of linker
8963@item
8964If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8965@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8966
8967@cindex error on valid input
8968@item
ff5dcc92 8969If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8970
8971@cindex invalid input
8972@item
ff5dcc92 8973If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8974may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8975object files are correct.
8976
8977@item
8978If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8979improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8980@end itemize
8981
8982@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8983@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8984@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8985@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8986
8987A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8988products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8989recommend you contact that organization first.
8990
8991You can find contact information for many support companies and
8992individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8993distribution.
8994
ad22bfe8 8995@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8996Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8997@value{BUGURL}.
8998@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8999
9000The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9001@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9002fact or leave it out, state it!
9003
9004Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9005problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9006assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9007matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9008the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9009location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9010were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9011into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9012specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9013and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9014
9015Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9016the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9017on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9018
9019Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9020bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9021respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9022You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9023
9024To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9025
9026@itemize @bullet
9027@item
ff5dcc92 9028The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9029the @samp{--version} argument.
9030
9031Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9032the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9033
9034@item
ff5dcc92 9035Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9036patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9037
9038@item
9039The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9040version number.
9041
9042@item
ff5dcc92 9043What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9044``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9045
9046@item
9047The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9048observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9049list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9050sufficient.
9051
9052If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9053and then we might not encounter the bug.
9054
9055@item
9056A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9057bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9058provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9059bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9060state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9061requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9062we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9063attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9064
9065If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9066@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9067object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9068@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9069how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9070
9071@item
9072A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9073incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9074
ff5dcc92 9075Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9076will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9077not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9078a chance to make a mistake.
9079
9080Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9081say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9082copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9083C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9084and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9085fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9086you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9087any conclusion from our observations.
9088
9089@item
ff5dcc92 9090If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9091diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9092@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9093If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9094context, not by line number.
9095
9096The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9097sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9098@end itemize
9099
9100Here are some things that are not necessary:
9101
9102@itemize @bullet
9103@item
9104A description of the envelope of the bug.
9105
9106Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9107which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9108changes will not affect it.
9109
9110This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9111will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9112with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9113We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9114
9115Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9116of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9117output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9118less time, and so on.
9119
9120However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9121report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9122
9123@item
9124A patch for the bug.
9125
9126A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9127the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9128a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9129to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9130
ff5dcc92 9131Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9132construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9133through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9134able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9135fixed.
9136
9137And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9138patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9139help us to understand.
9140
9141@item
9142A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9143
9144Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9145things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9146@end itemize
9147
9148@node MRI
9149@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9150@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9151To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9152linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9153alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9154described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9155simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9156@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9157linker commands; these commands are described here.
9158
9159In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9160file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9161features to make use of them.
9162
9163You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9164@samp{-c} command-line option.
9165
9166Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9167command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9168blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9169MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9170issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9171
9172Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9173
9174You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9175lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9176The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9177
9178@table @code
9179@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9180@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9181@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9182Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9183the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9184@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9185your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9186script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9187commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9188input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9189@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9190
9191@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9192@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9193Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9194in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9195
9196@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9197
9198@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9199@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9200Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9201@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9202
9203@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9204@item BASE @var{expression}
9205Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9206absolute addresses) in the output file.
9207
9208@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9209@item CHIP @var{expression}
9210@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9211This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9212
9213@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9214@item END
9215This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9216
9217@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9218@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9219Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9220language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9221
9222@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9223@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9224Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9225@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9226
9227The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9228same line, with no change in its effect.
9229
9230@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9231@item LOAD @var{filename}
9232@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9233Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9234same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9235command line.
9236
9237@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9238@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9239@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9240MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9241option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9242
9243@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9244@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9245@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9246Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9247order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9248script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9249sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9250file, in the order specified.
9251
9252@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9253@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9254@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9255@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9256Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9257@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9258
9259@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9260@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9261@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9262@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9263You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9264specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9265If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9266@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9267@end table
9268
793c5807
NC
9269@node GNU Free Documentation License
9270@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9271@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9272
370b66a1
CD
9273@node LD Index
9274@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9275
9276@printindex cp
9277
9278@tex
7ca01ed9 9279% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9280% meantime:
9281\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9282\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9283\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9284\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9285\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9286\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9287\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9288\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9289\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9290% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9291@end tex
9292
252b5132 9293@bye
This page took 1.711998 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.